* config/i386/i386.c (output_fp_compare): Add generation
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / expr.c
blob83c8be5240f5986ddd0224c0c9667cb1c669b6aa
1 /* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1988, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
3 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GCC.
7 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
8 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
9 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
10 version.
12 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
13 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
14 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
15 for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
19 Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
20 02111-1307, USA. */
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
24 #include "coretypes.h"
25 #include "tm.h"
26 #include "machmode.h"
27 #include "real.h"
28 #include "rtl.h"
29 #include "tree.h"
30 #include "flags.h"
31 #include "regs.h"
32 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
33 #include "except.h"
34 #include "function.h"
35 #include "insn-config.h"
36 #include "insn-attr.h"
37 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
38 #include "expr.h"
39 #include "optabs.h"
40 #include "libfuncs.h"
41 #include "recog.h"
42 #include "reload.h"
43 #include "output.h"
44 #include "typeclass.h"
45 #include "toplev.h"
46 #include "ggc.h"
47 #include "langhooks.h"
48 #include "intl.h"
49 #include "tm_p.h"
50 #include "tree-iterator.h"
51 #include "tree-pass.h"
52 #include "tree-flow.h"
53 #include "target.h"
54 #include "timevar.h"
56 /* Decide whether a function's arguments should be processed
57 from first to last or from last to first.
59 They should if the stack and args grow in opposite directions, but
60 only if we have push insns. */
62 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
64 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
65 #if defined (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD) != defined (ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD)
66 #define PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED /* If it's last to first. */
67 #endif
68 #endif
70 #endif
72 #ifndef STACK_PUSH_CODE
73 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
74 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_DEC
75 #else
76 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_INC
77 #endif
78 #endif
81 /* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
82 around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
83 output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
84 indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
85 if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
86 the same indirect address eventually. */
87 int cse_not_expected;
89 /* This structure is used by move_by_pieces to describe the move to
90 be performed. */
91 struct move_by_pieces
93 rtx to;
94 rtx to_addr;
95 int autinc_to;
96 int explicit_inc_to;
97 rtx from;
98 rtx from_addr;
99 int autinc_from;
100 int explicit_inc_from;
101 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
102 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
103 int reverse;
106 /* This structure is used by store_by_pieces to describe the clear to
107 be performed. */
109 struct store_by_pieces
111 rtx to;
112 rtx to_addr;
113 int autinc_to;
114 int explicit_inc_to;
115 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
116 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
117 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
118 void *constfundata;
119 int reverse;
122 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
123 unsigned int,
124 unsigned int);
125 static void move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
126 struct move_by_pieces *);
127 static bool block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void);
128 static bool emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
129 static rtx emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx, rtx, rtx);
130 static tree emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int);
131 static void emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
132 static rtx clear_by_pieces_1 (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
133 static void clear_by_pieces (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
134 static void store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces *, unsigned int);
135 static void store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
136 struct store_by_pieces *);
137 static bool clear_storage_via_clrmem (rtx, rtx, unsigned);
138 static rtx clear_storage_via_libcall (rtx, rtx);
139 static tree clear_storage_libcall_fn (int);
140 static rtx compress_float_constant (rtx, rtx);
141 static rtx get_subtarget (rtx);
142 static void store_constructor_field (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
143 HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
144 tree, tree, int, int);
145 static void store_constructor (tree, rtx, int, HOST_WIDE_INT);
146 static rtx store_field (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
147 tree, enum machine_mode, int, tree, int);
149 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor (tree);
150 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor_for_target (tree, tree);
152 static int is_aligning_offset (tree, tree);
153 static void expand_operands (tree, tree, rtx, rtx*, rtx*,
154 enum expand_modifier);
155 static rtx reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx, rtx, tree);
156 static rtx do_store_flag (tree, rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
157 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
158 static void emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode, rtx, tree);
159 #endif
160 static void do_tablejump (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx);
161 static rtx const_vector_from_tree (tree);
163 /* Record for each mode whether we can move a register directly to or
164 from an object of that mode in memory. If we can't, we won't try
165 to use that mode directly when accessing a field of that mode. */
167 static char direct_load[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
168 static char direct_store[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
170 /* Record for each mode whether we can float-extend from memory. */
172 static bool float_extend_from_mem[NUM_MACHINE_MODES][NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
174 /* This macro is used to determine whether move_by_pieces should be called
175 to perform a structure copy. */
176 #ifndef MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
177 #define MOVE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
178 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
179 < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO)
180 #endif
182 /* This macro is used to determine whether clear_by_pieces should be
183 called to clear storage. */
184 #ifndef CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P
185 #define CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
186 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
187 < (unsigned int) CLEAR_RATIO)
188 #endif
190 /* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
191 called to "memset" storage with byte values other than zero, or
192 to "memcpy" storage when the source is a constant string. */
193 #ifndef STORE_BY_PIECES_P
194 #define STORE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
195 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
196 < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO)
197 #endif
199 /* This array records the insn_code of insns to perform block moves. */
200 enum insn_code movmem_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
202 /* This array records the insn_code of insns to perform block clears. */
203 enum insn_code clrmem_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
205 /* These arrays record the insn_code of two different kinds of insns
206 to perform block compares. */
207 enum insn_code cmpstr_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
208 enum insn_code cmpmem_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
210 /* SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS is nonzero if unaligned accesses are very slow. */
212 #ifndef SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
213 #define SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS(MODE, ALIGN) STRICT_ALIGNMENT
214 #endif
216 /* This is run once per compilation to set up which modes can be used
217 directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. */
219 void
220 init_expr_once (void)
222 rtx insn, pat;
223 enum machine_mode mode;
224 int num_clobbers;
225 rtx mem, mem1;
226 rtx reg;
228 /* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
229 It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
230 With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
231 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
232 mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, frame_pointer_rtx);
234 /* A scratch register we can modify in-place below to avoid
235 useless RTL allocations. */
236 reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
238 insn = rtx_alloc (INSN);
239 pat = gen_rtx_SET (0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
240 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
242 for (mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
243 mode = (enum machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
245 int regno;
247 direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
248 PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
249 PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
250 PUT_MODE (reg, mode);
252 /* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
253 directly loaded or stored from memory. */
255 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
256 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
257 && (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
258 regno++)
260 if (! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, mode))
261 continue;
263 REGNO (reg) = regno;
265 SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
266 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
267 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
268 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
270 SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
271 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
272 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
273 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
275 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
276 SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
277 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
278 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
280 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
281 SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
282 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
283 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
287 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_raw_REG (Pmode, 10000));
289 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); mode != VOIDmode;
290 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
292 enum machine_mode srcmode;
293 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); srcmode != mode;
294 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
296 enum insn_code ic;
298 ic = can_extend_p (mode, srcmode, 0);
299 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
300 continue;
302 PUT_MODE (mem, srcmode);
304 if ((*insn_data[ic].operand[1].predicate) (mem, srcmode))
305 float_extend_from_mem[mode][srcmode] = true;
310 /* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
312 void
313 init_expr (void)
315 cfun->expr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct expr_status));
318 /* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
319 Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating.
320 UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
321 This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
323 void
324 convert_move (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
326 enum machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
327 enum machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
328 int to_real = GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_FLOAT;
329 int from_real = GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_FLOAT;
330 enum insn_code code;
331 rtx libcall;
333 /* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
334 enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp < 0 ? UNKNOWN
335 : (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND));
338 gcc_assert (to_real == from_real);
340 /* If the source and destination are already the same, then there's
341 nothing to do. */
342 if (to == from)
343 return;
345 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
346 the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
347 TO here. */
349 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
350 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (from)))
351 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
352 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (from) == unsignedp)
353 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, from), from_mode = to_mode;
355 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (to) != SUBREG || !SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to));
357 if (to_mode == from_mode
358 || (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
360 emit_move_insn (to, from);
361 return;
364 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from_mode))
366 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode));
368 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode))
369 from = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, from, GET_MODE (from), 0);
370 else
371 to = simplify_gen_subreg (from_mode, to, GET_MODE (to), 0);
373 emit_move_insn (to, from);
374 return;
377 if (GET_CODE (to) == CONCAT && GET_CODE (from) == CONCAT)
379 convert_move (XEXP (to, 0), XEXP (from, 0), unsignedp);
380 convert_move (XEXP (to, 1), XEXP (from, 1), unsignedp);
381 return;
384 if (to_real)
386 rtx value, insns;
387 convert_optab tab;
389 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode)
390 != GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode));
392 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
393 tab = sext_optab;
394 else
395 tab = trunc_optab;
397 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
399 code = tab->handlers[to_mode][from_mode].insn_code;
400 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
402 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from,
403 tab == sext_optab ? FLOAT_EXTEND : FLOAT_TRUNCATE);
404 return;
407 /* Otherwise use a libcall. */
408 libcall = tab->handlers[to_mode][from_mode].libfunc;
410 /* Is this conversion implemented yet? */
411 gcc_assert (libcall);
413 start_sequence ();
414 value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, LCT_CONST, to_mode,
415 1, from, from_mode);
416 insns = get_insns ();
417 end_sequence ();
418 emit_libcall_block (insns, to, value,
419 tab == trunc_optab ? gen_rtx_FLOAT_TRUNCATE (to_mode,
420 from)
421 : gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (to_mode, from));
422 return;
425 /* Handle pointer conversion. */ /* SPEE 900220. */
426 /* Targets are expected to provide conversion insns between PxImode and
427 xImode for all MODE_PARTIAL_INT modes they use, but no others. */
428 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
430 enum machine_mode full_mode
431 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode), MODE_INT);
433 gcc_assert (trunc_optab->handlers[to_mode][full_mode].insn_code
434 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
436 if (full_mode != from_mode)
437 from = convert_to_mode (full_mode, from, unsignedp);
438 emit_unop_insn (trunc_optab->handlers[to_mode][full_mode].insn_code,
439 to, from, UNKNOWN);
440 return;
442 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
444 enum machine_mode full_mode
445 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode), MODE_INT);
447 gcc_assert (sext_optab->handlers[full_mode][from_mode].insn_code
448 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
450 emit_unop_insn (sext_optab->handlers[full_mode][from_mode].insn_code,
451 to, from, UNKNOWN);
452 if (to_mode == full_mode)
453 return;
455 /* else proceed to integer conversions below. */
456 from_mode = full_mode;
459 /* Now both modes are integers. */
461 /* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
462 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)
463 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
465 rtx insns;
466 rtx lowpart;
467 rtx fill_value;
468 rtx lowfrom;
469 int i;
470 enum machine_mode lowpart_mode;
471 int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
473 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
474 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
475 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
477 /* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
478 so that we always generate the same set of insns for
479 better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
480 we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
481 if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
482 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
483 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
484 return;
486 /* Next, try converting via full word. */
487 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
488 && ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
489 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
491 if (REG_P (to))
493 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
494 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
495 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, to));
497 convert_move (gen_lowpart (word_mode, to), from, unsignedp);
498 emit_unop_insn (code, to,
499 gen_lowpart (word_mode, to), equiv_code);
500 return;
503 /* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
504 start_sequence ();
506 /* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure
507 that the source does not overlap the target. */
509 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
510 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
512 /* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
513 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
514 lowpart_mode = word_mode;
515 else
516 lowpart_mode = from_mode;
518 lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
520 lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
521 emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
523 /* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
524 if (unsignedp)
525 fill_value = const0_rtx;
526 else
528 #ifdef HAVE_slt
529 if (HAVE_slt
530 && insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_slt].operand[0].mode == word_mode
531 && STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
533 emit_cmp_insn (lowfrom, const0_rtx, NE, NULL_RTX,
534 lowpart_mode, 0);
535 fill_value = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
536 emit_insn (gen_slt (fill_value));
538 else
539 #endif
541 fill_value
542 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, lowpart_mode, lowfrom,
543 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (lowpart_mode) - 1),
544 NULL_RTX, 0);
545 fill_value = convert_to_mode (word_mode, fill_value, 1);
549 /* Fill the remaining words. */
550 for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
552 int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
553 rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
555 gcc_assert (subword);
557 if (fill_value != subword)
558 emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
561 insns = get_insns ();
562 end_sequence ();
564 emit_no_conflict_block (insns, to, from, NULL_RTX,
565 gen_rtx_fmt_e (equiv_code, to_mode, copy_rtx (from)));
566 return;
569 /* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
570 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
571 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
573 if (!((MEM_P (from)
574 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
575 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
576 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
577 || REG_P (from)
578 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
579 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
580 convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
581 return;
584 /* Now follow all the conversions between integers
585 no more than a word long. */
587 /* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
588 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
589 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
590 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)))
592 if (!((MEM_P (from)
593 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
594 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
595 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
596 || REG_P (from)
597 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
598 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
599 if (REG_P (from) && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
600 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (from), to_mode))
601 from = copy_to_reg (from);
602 emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
603 return;
606 /* Handle extension. */
607 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode))
609 /* Convert directly if that works. */
610 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
611 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
613 if (flag_force_mem)
614 from = force_not_mem (from);
616 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
617 return;
619 else
621 enum machine_mode intermediate;
622 rtx tmp;
623 tree shift_amount;
625 /* Search for a mode to convert via. */
626 for (intermediate = from_mode; intermediate != VOIDmode;
627 intermediate = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (intermediate))
628 if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
629 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
630 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
631 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
632 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (intermediate))))
633 && (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
634 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
636 convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
637 unsignedp), unsignedp);
638 return;
641 /* No suitable intermediate mode.
642 Generate what we need with shifts. */
643 shift_amount = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
644 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)
645 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode));
646 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
647 tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
648 to, unsignedp);
649 tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
650 to, unsignedp);
651 if (tmp != to)
652 emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
653 return;
657 /* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
658 if (trunc_optab->handlers[to_mode][from_mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
660 emit_unop_insn (trunc_optab->handlers[to_mode][from_mode].insn_code,
661 to, from, UNKNOWN);
662 return;
665 /* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
666 the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
667 and for which there was no special instruction.
669 ??? Code above formerly short-circuited this, for most integer
670 mode pairs, with a force_reg in from_mode followed by a recursive
671 call to this routine. Appears always to have been wrong. */
672 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode))
674 rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
675 emit_move_insn (to, temp);
676 return;
679 /* Mode combination is not recognized. */
680 gcc_unreachable ();
683 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
684 from converting X to mode MODE.
685 Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
686 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
687 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
688 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion. */
691 convert_to_mode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
693 return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
696 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
697 from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
698 Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
699 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
701 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
702 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
704 You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode. */
707 convert_modes (enum machine_mode mode, enum machine_mode oldmode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
709 rtx temp;
711 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
712 the required extension, strip it. */
714 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
715 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))) >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
716 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (x) == unsignedp)
717 x = gen_lowpart (mode, x);
719 if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
720 oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
722 if (mode == oldmode)
723 return x;
725 /* There is one case that we must handle specially: If we are converting
726 a CONST_INT into a mode whose size is twice HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT and
727 we are to interpret the constant as unsigned, gen_lowpart will do
728 the wrong if the constant appears negative. What we want to do is
729 make the high-order word of the constant zero, not all ones. */
731 if (unsignedp && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
732 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
733 && GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (x) < 0)
735 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
737 if (oldmode != VOIDmode
738 && HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode))
740 int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode);
742 /* We need to zero extend VAL. */
743 val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
746 return immed_double_const (val, (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0, mode);
749 /* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
750 are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
751 non-volatile MEM. Except for the constant case where MODE is no
752 wider than HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, we must be narrowing the operand. */
754 if ((GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
755 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
756 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
757 && GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) == MODE_INT
758 && (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE
759 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (oldmode)
760 && ((MEM_P (x) && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (x)
761 && direct_load[(int) mode])
762 || (REG_P (x)
763 && (! HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
764 || HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (x), mode))
765 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
766 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))))))))
768 /* ?? If we don't know OLDMODE, we have to assume here that
769 X does not need sign- or zero-extension. This may not be
770 the case, but it's the best we can do. */
771 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && oldmode != VOIDmode
772 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (oldmode))
774 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
775 int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode);
777 /* We must sign or zero-extend in this case. Start by
778 zero-extending, then sign extend if we need to. */
779 val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
780 if (! unsignedp
781 && (val & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1))))
782 val |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << width;
784 return gen_int_mode (val, mode);
787 return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
790 /* Converting from integer constant into mode is always equivalent to an
791 subreg operation. */
792 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode) && GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
794 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
795 return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, x, oldmode, 0);
798 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
799 convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
800 return temp;
803 /* STORE_MAX_PIECES is the number of bytes at a time that we can
804 store efficiently. Due to internal GCC limitations, this is
805 MOVE_MAX_PIECES limited by the number of bytes GCC can represent
806 for an immediate constant. */
808 #define STORE_MAX_PIECES MIN (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
810 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes can be moved by using several move
811 instructions. Return nonzero if a call to move_by_pieces should
812 succeed. */
815 can_move_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
816 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
818 return MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align);
821 /* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes from block FROM to
822 block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
824 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
825 used to push FROM to the stack.
827 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
829 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
830 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
831 stpcpy. */
834 move_by_pieces (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
835 unsigned int align, int endp)
837 struct move_by_pieces data;
838 rtx to_addr, from_addr = XEXP (from, 0);
839 unsigned int max_size = MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
840 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
841 enum insn_code icode;
843 align = MIN (to ? MEM_ALIGN (to) : align, MEM_ALIGN (from));
845 data.offset = 0;
846 data.from_addr = from_addr;
847 if (to)
849 to_addr = XEXP (to, 0);
850 data.to = to;
851 data.autinc_to
852 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
853 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
854 data.reverse
855 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
857 else
859 to_addr = NULL_RTX;
860 data.to = NULL_RTX;
861 data.autinc_to = 1;
862 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
863 data.reverse = 1;
864 #else
865 data.reverse = 0;
866 #endif
868 data.to_addr = to_addr;
869 data.from = from;
870 data.autinc_from
871 = (GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_DEC
872 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_INC
873 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_DEC);
875 data.explicit_inc_from = 0;
876 data.explicit_inc_to = 0;
877 if (data.reverse) data.offset = len;
878 data.len = len;
880 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
881 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
882 and use post-increment if available. */
883 if (!(data.autinc_from && data.autinc_to)
884 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (len, align, max_size) > 2)
886 /* Find the mode of the largest move... */
887 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
888 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
889 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
890 mode = tmode;
892 if (USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_from)
894 data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (from_addr, len));
895 data.autinc_from = 1;
896 data.explicit_inc_from = -1;
898 if (USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.autinc_from)
900 data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (from_addr);
901 data.autinc_from = 1;
902 data.explicit_inc_from = 1;
904 if (!data.autinc_from && CONSTANT_P (from_addr))
905 data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (from_addr);
906 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
908 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (to_addr, len));
909 data.autinc_to = 1;
910 data.explicit_inc_to = -1;
912 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
914 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
915 data.autinc_to = 1;
916 data.explicit_inc_to = 1;
918 if (!data.autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
919 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
922 tmode = mode_for_size (MOVE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
923 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
924 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
925 else
927 enum machine_mode xmode;
929 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
930 tmode != VOIDmode;
931 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
932 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > MOVE_MAX_PIECES
933 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
934 break;
936 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
939 /* First move what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
940 successively smaller modes. */
942 while (max_size > 1)
944 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
945 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
946 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
947 mode = tmode;
949 if (mode == VOIDmode)
950 break;
952 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
953 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
954 move_by_pieces_1 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, &data);
956 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
959 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
960 gcc_assert (!data.len);
962 if (endp)
964 rtx to1;
966 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
967 if (data.autinc_to)
969 if (endp == 2)
971 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
972 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
973 else
974 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (data.to_addr,
975 -1));
977 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
978 data.offset);
980 else
982 if (endp == 2)
983 --data.offset;
984 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
986 return to1;
988 else
989 return data.to;
992 /* Return number of insns required to move L bytes by pieces.
993 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
995 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
996 move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l, unsigned int align,
997 unsigned int max_size)
999 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_insns = 0;
1000 enum machine_mode tmode;
1002 tmode = mode_for_size (MOVE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
1003 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
1004 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
1005 else
1007 enum machine_mode tmode, xmode;
1009 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
1010 tmode != VOIDmode;
1011 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
1012 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > MOVE_MAX_PIECES
1013 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
1014 break;
1016 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
1019 while (max_size > 1)
1021 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
1022 enum insn_code icode;
1024 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
1025 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
1026 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
1027 mode = tmode;
1029 if (mode == VOIDmode)
1030 break;
1032 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
1033 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1034 n_insns += l / GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), l %= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1036 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1039 gcc_assert (!l);
1040 return n_insns;
1043 /* Subroutine of move_by_pieces. Move as many bytes as appropriate
1044 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
1045 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
1047 static void
1048 move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
1049 struct move_by_pieces *data)
1051 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1052 rtx to1 = NULL_RTX, from1;
1054 while (data->len >= size)
1056 if (data->reverse)
1057 data->offset -= size;
1059 if (data->to)
1061 if (data->autinc_to)
1062 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
1063 data->offset);
1064 else
1065 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
1068 if (data->autinc_from)
1069 from1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->from, mode, data->from_addr,
1070 data->offset);
1071 else
1072 from1 = adjust_address (data->from, mode, data->offset);
1074 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
1075 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
1076 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1077 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from < 0)
1078 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr,
1079 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1081 if (data->to)
1082 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, from1));
1083 else
1085 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
1086 emit_single_push_insn (mode, from1, NULL);
1087 #else
1088 gcc_unreachable ();
1089 #endif
1092 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
1093 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1094 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from > 0)
1095 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1097 if (! data->reverse)
1098 data->offset += size;
1100 data->len -= size;
1104 /* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
1105 string-move instructions, with multiple scalar move instructions,
1106 or with a library call.
1108 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE) with mode BLKmode.
1109 SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
1110 ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have.
1111 METHOD describes what kind of copy this is, and what mechanisms may be used.
1113 Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
1114 0 otherwise. */
1117 emit_block_move (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
1119 bool may_use_call;
1120 rtx retval = 0;
1121 unsigned int align;
1123 switch (method)
1125 case BLOCK_OP_NORMAL:
1126 may_use_call = true;
1127 break;
1129 case BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM:
1130 may_use_call = block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm ();
1132 /* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
1133 to force it to pop the arguments right away. */
1134 NO_DEFER_POP;
1135 break;
1137 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL:
1138 may_use_call = false;
1139 break;
1141 default:
1142 gcc_unreachable ();
1145 align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
1147 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
1148 gcc_assert (MEM_P (y));
1149 gcc_assert (size);
1151 /* Make sure we've got BLKmode addresses; store_one_arg can decide that
1152 block copy is more efficient for other large modes, e.g. DCmode. */
1153 x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
1154 y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
1156 /* Set MEM_SIZE as appropriate for this block copy. The main place this
1157 can be incorrect is coming from __builtin_memcpy. */
1158 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
1160 if (INTVAL (size) == 0)
1161 return 0;
1163 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
1164 y = shallow_copy_rtx (y);
1165 set_mem_size (x, size);
1166 set_mem_size (y, size);
1169 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT && MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
1170 move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align, 0);
1171 else if (emit_block_move_via_movmem (x, y, size, align))
1173 else if (may_use_call)
1174 retval = emit_block_move_via_libcall (x, y, size);
1175 else
1176 emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align);
1178 if (method == BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM)
1179 OK_DEFER_POP;
1181 return retval;
1184 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Returns true if calling the
1185 block move libcall will not clobber any parameters which may have
1186 already been placed on the stack. */
1188 static bool
1189 block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void)
1191 /* If arguments are pushed on the stack, then they're safe. */
1192 if (PUSH_ARGS)
1193 return true;
1195 /* If registers go on the stack anyway, any argument is sure to clobber
1196 an outgoing argument. */
1197 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE) && defined (OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1199 tree fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1200 (void) fn;
1201 if (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fn) != 0)
1202 return false;
1204 #endif
1206 /* If any argument goes in memory, then it might clobber an outgoing
1207 argument. */
1209 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far;
1210 tree fn, arg;
1212 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1213 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far, TREE_TYPE (fn), NULL_RTX, 0, 3);
1215 arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fn));
1216 for ( ; arg != void_list_node ; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
1218 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (arg));
1219 rtx tmp = FUNCTION_ARG (args_so_far, mode, NULL_TREE, 1);
1220 if (!tmp || !REG_P (tmp))
1221 return false;
1222 if (FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (args_so_far, mode,
1223 NULL_TREE, 1))
1224 return false;
1225 FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (args_so_far, mode, NULL_TREE, 1);
1228 return true;
1231 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a movmem pattern;
1232 return true if successful. */
1234 static bool
1235 emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, unsigned int align)
1237 rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1238 int save_volatile_ok = volatile_ok;
1239 enum machine_mode mode;
1241 /* Since this is a move insn, we don't care about volatility. */
1242 volatile_ok = 1;
1244 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
1245 including more than one in the machine description unless
1246 the more limited one has some advantage. */
1248 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
1249 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
1251 enum insn_code code = movmem_optab[(int) mode];
1252 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
1254 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
1255 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
1256 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
1257 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
1258 actual mode mask. */
1259 && ((GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
1260 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
1261 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
1262 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
1263 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate) == 0
1264 || (*pred) (x, BLKmode))
1265 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate) == 0
1266 || (*pred) (y, BLKmode))
1267 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[3].predicate) == 0
1268 || (*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode)))
1270 rtx op2;
1271 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
1272 rtx pat;
1274 op2 = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
1275 pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate;
1276 if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (op2, mode))
1277 op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op2);
1279 /* ??? When called via emit_block_move_for_call, it'd be
1280 nice if there were some way to inform the backend, so
1281 that it doesn't fail the expansion because it thinks
1282 emitting the libcall would be more efficient. */
1284 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (x, y, op2, opalign);
1285 if (pat)
1287 emit_insn (pat);
1288 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1289 return true;
1291 else
1292 delete_insns_since (last);
1296 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1297 return false;
1300 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a call to memcpy.
1301 Return the return value from memcpy, 0 otherwise. */
1303 static rtx
1304 emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx dst, rtx src, rtx size)
1306 rtx dst_addr, src_addr;
1307 tree call_expr, arg_list, fn, src_tree, dst_tree, size_tree;
1308 enum machine_mode size_mode;
1309 rtx retval;
1311 /* Emit code to copy the addresses of DST and SRC and SIZE into new
1312 pseudos. We can then place those new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and
1313 use them later. */
1315 dst_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (dst, 0));
1316 src_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (src, 0));
1318 dst_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, dst_addr);
1319 src_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, src_addr);
1321 dst_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, dst_addr);
1322 src_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, src_addr);
1324 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
1326 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
1327 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
1329 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
1330 memcpy in this context. This could be a user call to memcpy and
1331 the user may wish to examine the return value from memcpy. For
1332 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
1333 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
1335 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
1337 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (true);
1338 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, size_tree, NULL_TREE);
1339 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, src_tree, arg_list);
1340 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, dst_tree, arg_list);
1342 /* Now we have to build up the CALL_EXPR itself. */
1343 call_expr = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fn)), fn);
1344 call_expr = build3 (CALL_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fn)),
1345 call_expr, arg_list, NULL_TREE);
1347 retval = expand_expr (call_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
1349 return retval;
1352 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move_via_libcall. Create the tree node
1353 for the function we use for block copies. The first time FOR_CALL
1354 is true, we call assemble_external. */
1356 static GTY(()) tree block_move_fn;
1358 void
1359 init_block_move_fn (const char *asmspec)
1361 if (!block_move_fn)
1363 tree args, fn;
1365 fn = get_identifier ("memcpy");
1366 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
1367 const_ptr_type_node, sizetype,
1368 NULL_TREE);
1370 fn = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
1371 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
1372 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
1373 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
1374 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
1376 block_move_fn = fn;
1379 if (asmspec)
1380 set_user_assembler_name (block_move_fn, asmspec);
1383 static tree
1384 emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int for_call)
1386 static bool emitted_extern;
1388 if (!block_move_fn)
1389 init_block_move_fn (NULL);
1391 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
1393 emitted_extern = true;
1394 make_decl_rtl (block_move_fn);
1395 assemble_external (block_move_fn);
1398 return block_move_fn;
1401 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Copy the data via an explicit
1402 loop. This is used only when libcalls are forbidden. */
1403 /* ??? It'd be nice to copy in hunks larger than QImode. */
1405 static void
1406 emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
1407 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1409 rtx cmp_label, top_label, iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
1410 enum machine_mode iter_mode;
1412 iter_mode = GET_MODE (size);
1413 if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
1414 iter_mode = word_mode;
1416 top_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1417 cmp_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1418 iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
1420 emit_move_insn (iter, const0_rtx);
1422 x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
1423 y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
1424 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
1426 emit_jump (cmp_label);
1427 emit_label (top_label);
1429 tmp = convert_modes (Pmode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1430 x_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, x_addr, tmp);
1431 y_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, y_addr, tmp);
1432 x = change_address (x, QImode, x_addr);
1433 y = change_address (y, QImode, y_addr);
1435 emit_move_insn (x, y);
1437 tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, const1_rtx, iter,
1438 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1439 if (tmp != iter)
1440 emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
1442 emit_label (cmp_label);
1444 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, size, LT, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
1445 true, top_label);
1448 /* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
1449 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1451 void
1452 move_block_to_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs, enum machine_mode mode)
1454 int i;
1455 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1456 rtx pat;
1457 rtx last;
1458 #endif
1460 if (nregs == 0)
1461 return;
1463 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
1464 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
1466 /* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
1467 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1468 if (HAVE_load_multiple)
1470 last = get_last_insn ();
1471 pat = gen_load_multiple (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno), x,
1472 GEN_INT (nregs));
1473 if (pat)
1475 emit_insn (pat);
1476 return;
1478 else
1479 delete_insns_since (last);
1481 #endif
1483 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1484 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
1485 operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
1488 /* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
1489 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1491 void
1492 move_block_from_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs)
1494 int i;
1496 if (nregs == 0)
1497 return;
1499 /* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
1500 #ifdef HAVE_store_multiple
1501 if (HAVE_store_multiple)
1503 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
1504 rtx pat = gen_store_multiple (x, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno),
1505 GEN_INT (nregs));
1506 if (pat)
1508 emit_insn (pat);
1509 return;
1511 else
1512 delete_insns_since (last);
1514 #endif
1516 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1518 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
1520 gcc_assert (tem);
1522 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
1526 /* Generate a PARALLEL rtx for a new non-consecutive group of registers from
1527 ORIG, where ORIG is a non-consecutive group of registers represented by
1528 a PARALLEL. The clone is identical to the original except in that the
1529 original set of registers is replaced by a new set of pseudo registers.
1530 The new set has the same modes as the original set. */
1533 gen_group_rtx (rtx orig)
1535 int i, length;
1536 rtx *tmps;
1538 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (orig) == PARALLEL);
1540 length = XVECLEN (orig, 0);
1541 tmps = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * length);
1543 /* Skip a NULL entry in first slot. */
1544 i = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1;
1546 if (i)
1547 tmps[0] = 0;
1549 for (; i < length; i++)
1551 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 0));
1552 rtx offset = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 1);
1554 tmps[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_reg_rtx (mode), offset);
1557 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (orig), gen_rtvec_v (length, tmps));
1560 /* Emit code to move a block ORIG_SRC of type TYPE to a block DST,
1561 where DST is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1562 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_SRC in bytes, or -1
1563 if not known. */
1565 void
1566 emit_group_load (rtx dst, rtx orig_src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ssize)
1568 rtx *tmps, src;
1569 int start, i;
1571 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL);
1573 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1574 both on the stack and in registers. */
1575 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
1576 start = 0;
1577 else
1578 start = 1;
1580 tmps = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1582 /* Process the pieces. */
1583 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1585 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
1586 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
1587 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1588 int shift = 0;
1590 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
1591 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
1593 /* Arrange to shift the fragment to where it belongs.
1594 extract_bit_field loads to the lsb of the reg. */
1595 if (
1596 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
1597 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_src), type, i == start)
1598 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
1599 #else
1600 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
1601 #endif
1603 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1604 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
1605 gcc_assert (bytelen > 0);
1608 /* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
1609 from strange tricks we might play; but make sure that the source can
1610 be loaded directly into the destination. */
1611 src = orig_src;
1612 if (!MEM_P (orig_src)
1613 && (!CONSTANT_P (orig_src)
1614 || (GET_MODE (orig_src) != mode
1615 && GET_MODE (orig_src) != VOIDmode)))
1617 if (GET_MODE (orig_src) == VOIDmode)
1618 src = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1619 else
1620 src = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1622 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1625 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
1626 if (MEM_P (src)
1627 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (src))
1628 || MEM_ALIGN (src) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1629 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
1630 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1632 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1633 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], adjust_address (src, mode, bytepos));
1635 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
1637 unsigned int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1638 unsigned int slen0 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)));
1640 if ((bytepos == 0 && bytelen == slen0)
1641 || (bytepos != 0 && bytepos + bytelen <= slen))
1643 /* The following assumes that the concatenated objects all
1644 have the same size. In this case, a simple calculation
1645 can be used to determine the object and the bit field
1646 to be extracted. */
1647 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, bytepos / slen0);
1648 if (! CONSTANT_P (tmps[i])
1649 && (!REG_P (tmps[i]) || GET_MODE (tmps[i]) != mode))
1650 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (tmps[i], bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1651 (bytepos % slen0) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1652 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1654 else
1656 rtx mem;
1658 gcc_assert (!bytepos);
1659 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen, 0);
1660 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1661 tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, 0);
1664 /* FIXME: A SIMD parallel will eventually lead to a subreg of a
1665 SIMD register, which is currently broken. While we get GCC
1666 to emit proper RTL for these cases, let's dump to memory. */
1667 else if (VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dst))
1668 && REG_P (src))
1670 int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1671 rtx mem;
1673 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen, 0);
1674 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1675 tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, (int) bytepos);
1677 else if (CONSTANT_P (src) && GET_MODE (dst) != BLKmode
1678 && XVECLEN (dst, 0) > 1)
1679 tmps[i] = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, src, GET_MODE(dst), bytepos);
1680 else if (CONSTANT_P (src)
1681 || (REG_P (src) && GET_MODE (src) == mode))
1682 tmps[i] = src;
1683 else
1684 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1685 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, NULL_RTX,
1686 mode, mode);
1688 if (shift)
1689 tmps[i] = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
1690 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, shift), tmps[i], 0);
1693 /* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
1694 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1695 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0), tmps[i]);
1698 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to block DST, where SRC and DST are
1699 non-consecutive groups of registers, each represented by a PARALLEL. */
1701 void
1702 emit_group_move (rtx dst, rtx src)
1704 int i;
1706 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL
1707 && GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL
1708 && XVECLEN (src, 0) == XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1710 /* Skip first entry if NULL. */
1711 for (i = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1712 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0),
1713 XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0));
1716 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block ORIG_DST of type TYPE,
1717 where SRC is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1718 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_DST, or -1 if not
1719 known. */
1721 void
1722 emit_group_store (rtx orig_dst, rtx src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ssize)
1724 rtx *tmps, dst;
1725 int start, i;
1727 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL);
1729 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1730 both on the stack and in registers. */
1731 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
1732 start = 0;
1733 else
1734 start = 1;
1736 tmps = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * XVECLEN (src, 0));
1738 /* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
1739 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1741 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
1742 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
1743 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
1746 /* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
1747 from strange tricks we might play. */
1748 dst = orig_dst;
1749 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
1751 rtx temp;
1753 /* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
1754 a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
1755 so no action is necessary. */
1756 if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
1757 return;
1759 /* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
1760 it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
1761 the temporary. */
1763 temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize, 0);
1764 emit_group_store (temp, src, type, ssize);
1765 emit_group_load (dst, temp, type, ssize);
1766 return;
1768 else if (!MEM_P (dst) && GET_CODE (dst) != CONCAT)
1770 dst = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_dst));
1771 /* Make life a bit easier for combine. */
1772 emit_move_insn (dst, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (orig_dst)));
1775 /* Process the pieces. */
1776 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1778 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
1779 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
1780 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1781 rtx dest = dst;
1783 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
1784 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
1786 /* store_bit_field always takes its value from the lsb.
1787 Move the fragment to the lsb if it's not already there. */
1788 if (
1789 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
1790 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_dst), type, i == start)
1791 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
1792 #else
1793 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
1794 #endif
1797 int shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1798 tmps[i] = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
1799 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, shift),
1800 tmps[i], 0);
1802 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
1805 if (GET_CODE (dst) == CONCAT)
1807 if (bytepos + bytelen <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
1808 dest = XEXP (dst, 0);
1809 else if (bytepos >= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
1811 bytepos -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)));
1812 dest = XEXP (dst, 1);
1814 else
1816 gcc_assert (bytepos == 0 && XVECLEN (src, 0));
1817 dest = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dest),
1818 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest)), 0);
1819 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, GET_MODE (tmps[i]), bytepos),
1820 tmps[i]);
1821 dst = dest;
1822 break;
1826 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
1827 if (MEM_P (dest)
1828 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (dest))
1829 || MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1830 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
1831 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1832 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, bytepos), tmps[i]);
1833 else
1834 store_bit_field (dest, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1835 mode, tmps[i]);
1838 /* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
1839 if (orig_dst != dst)
1840 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
1843 /* Generate code to copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a
1844 set of registers starting with SRCREG into TGTBLK. If TGTBLK
1845 is null, a stack temporary is created. TGTBLK is returned.
1847 The purpose of this routine is to handle functions that return
1848 BLKmode structures in registers. Some machines (the PA for example)
1849 want to return all small structures in registers regardless of the
1850 structure's alignment. */
1853 copy_blkmode_from_reg (rtx tgtblk, rtx srcreg, tree type)
1855 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
1856 rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
1857 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), BITS_PER_WORD);
1858 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0;
1860 if (tgtblk == 0)
1862 tgtblk = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type,
1863 (TYPE_QUALS (type)
1864 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST)),
1865 0, 1, 1);
1866 preserve_temp_slots (tgtblk);
1869 /* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't, copy it
1870 into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
1872 if (GET_MODE (srcreg) != BLKmode
1873 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (srcreg)) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
1874 srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
1876 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see whether
1877 SRCREG is padded on the left or on the right. If it's on the left,
1878 set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of bits to skip.
1880 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
1881 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
1882 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
1883 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
1884 end of the register. */
1885 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
1886 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (type)
1887 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
1888 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
1889 padding_correction
1890 = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD) * BITS_PER_UNIT));
1892 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bites at a time.
1894 We could probably emit more efficient code for machines which do not use
1895 strict alignment, but it doesn't seem worth the effort at the current
1896 time. */
1897 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
1898 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1899 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
1901 /* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
1902 word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
1903 (the first time through). */
1904 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
1905 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
1906 src = operand_subword_force (srcreg, xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD,
1907 GET_MODE (srcreg));
1909 /* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
1910 a word boundary. */
1911 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
1912 dst = operand_subword (tgtblk, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, BLKmode);
1914 /* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
1915 xbitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
1916 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, word_mode,
1917 extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
1918 xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
1919 NULL_RTX, word_mode, word_mode));
1922 return tgtblk;
1925 /* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
1926 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
1928 void
1929 use_reg (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg)
1931 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg) && REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
1933 *call_fusage
1934 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
1935 gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
1938 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
1939 starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
1941 void
1942 use_regs (rtx *call_fusage, int regno, int nregs)
1944 int i;
1946 gcc_assert (regno + nregs <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
1948 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1949 use_reg (call_fusage, regno_reg_rtx[regno + i]);
1952 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
1953 PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
1954 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
1956 void
1957 use_group_regs (rtx *call_fusage, rtx regs)
1959 int i;
1961 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
1963 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
1965 /* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
1966 registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
1967 partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
1968 if (reg != 0 && REG_P (reg))
1969 use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
1974 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes generated by CONSTFUN can be
1975 stored to memory using several move instructions. CONSTFUNDATA is
1976 a pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
1977 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. Return nonzero if a
1978 call to store_by_pieces should succeed. */
1981 can_store_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1982 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
1983 void *constfundata, unsigned int align)
1985 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l;
1986 unsigned int max_size;
1987 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1988 enum machine_mode mode, tmode;
1989 enum insn_code icode;
1990 int reverse;
1991 rtx cst;
1993 if (len == 0)
1994 return 1;
1996 if (! STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align))
1997 return 0;
1999 tmode = mode_for_size (STORE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
2000 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
2001 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
2002 else
2004 enum machine_mode xmode;
2006 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
2007 tmode != VOIDmode;
2008 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2009 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > STORE_MAX_PIECES
2010 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
2011 break;
2013 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
2016 /* We would first store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2017 successively smaller modes. */
2019 for (reverse = 0;
2020 reverse <= (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT || HAVE_POST_DECREMENT);
2021 reverse++)
2023 l = len;
2024 mode = VOIDmode;
2025 max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2026 while (max_size > 1)
2028 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2029 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2030 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2031 mode = tmode;
2033 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2034 break;
2036 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
2037 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
2038 && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2040 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2042 while (l >= size)
2044 if (reverse)
2045 offset -= size;
2047 cst = (*constfun) (constfundata, offset, mode);
2048 if (!LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (cst))
2049 return 0;
2051 if (!reverse)
2052 offset += size;
2054 l -= size;
2058 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2061 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2062 gcc_assert (!l);
2065 return 1;
2068 /* Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes generated by
2069 CONSTFUN to block TO. (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). CONSTFUNDATA is a
2070 pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2071 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume.
2072 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
2073 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
2074 stpcpy. */
2077 store_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2078 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2079 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, int endp)
2081 struct store_by_pieces data;
2083 if (len == 0)
2085 gcc_assert (endp != 2);
2086 return to;
2089 gcc_assert (STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align));
2090 data.constfun = constfun;
2091 data.constfundata = constfundata;
2092 data.len = len;
2093 data.to = to;
2094 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2095 if (endp)
2097 rtx to1;
2099 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
2100 if (data.autinc_to)
2102 if (endp == 2)
2104 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
2105 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
2106 else
2107 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (data.to_addr,
2108 -1));
2110 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
2111 data.offset);
2113 else
2115 if (endp == 2)
2116 --data.offset;
2117 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
2119 return to1;
2121 else
2122 return data.to;
2125 /* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2126 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2128 static void
2129 clear_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
2131 struct store_by_pieces data;
2133 if (len == 0)
2134 return;
2136 data.constfun = clear_by_pieces_1;
2137 data.constfundata = NULL;
2138 data.len = len;
2139 data.to = to;
2140 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2143 /* Callback routine for clear_by_pieces.
2144 Return const0_rtx unconditionally. */
2146 static rtx
2147 clear_by_pieces_1 (void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2148 HOST_WIDE_INT offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2149 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2151 return const0_rtx;
2154 /* Subroutine of clear_by_pieces and store_by_pieces.
2155 Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2156 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2158 static void
2159 store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2160 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2162 rtx to_addr = XEXP (data->to, 0);
2163 unsigned int max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2164 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
2165 enum insn_code icode;
2167 data->offset = 0;
2168 data->to_addr = to_addr;
2169 data->autinc_to
2170 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
2171 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2173 data->explicit_inc_to = 0;
2174 data->reverse
2175 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2176 if (data->reverse)
2177 data->offset = data->len;
2179 /* If storing requires more than two move insns,
2180 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
2181 and use post-increment if available. */
2182 if (!data->autinc_to
2183 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (data->len, align, max_size) > 2)
2185 /* Determine the main mode we'll be using. */
2186 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2187 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2188 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2189 mode = tmode;
2191 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data->reverse && ! data->autinc_to)
2193 data->to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (to_addr, data->len));
2194 data->autinc_to = 1;
2195 data->explicit_inc_to = -1;
2198 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data->reverse
2199 && ! data->autinc_to)
2201 data->to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
2202 data->autinc_to = 1;
2203 data->explicit_inc_to = 1;
2206 if ( !data->autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
2207 data->to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
2210 tmode = mode_for_size (STORE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
2211 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
2212 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
2213 else
2215 enum machine_mode xmode;
2217 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
2218 tmode != VOIDmode;
2219 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2220 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > STORE_MAX_PIECES
2221 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
2222 break;
2224 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
2227 /* First store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2228 successively smaller modes. */
2230 while (max_size > 1)
2232 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2233 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2234 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2235 mode = tmode;
2237 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2238 break;
2240 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
2241 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2242 store_by_pieces_2 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, data);
2244 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2247 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2248 gcc_assert (!data->len);
2251 /* Subroutine of store_by_pieces_1. Store as many bytes as appropriate
2252 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
2253 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
2255 static void
2256 store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
2257 struct store_by_pieces *data)
2259 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2260 rtx to1, cst;
2262 while (data->len >= size)
2264 if (data->reverse)
2265 data->offset -= size;
2267 if (data->autinc_to)
2268 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
2269 data->offset);
2270 else
2271 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
2273 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
2274 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
2275 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) size)));
2277 cst = (*data->constfun) (data->constfundata, data->offset, mode);
2278 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, cst));
2280 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
2281 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
2283 if (! data->reverse)
2284 data->offset += size;
2286 data->len -= size;
2290 /* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT. If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is
2291 its length in bytes. */
2294 clear_storage (rtx object, rtx size)
2296 rtx retval = 0;
2297 unsigned int align = (MEM_P (object) ? MEM_ALIGN (object)
2298 : GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (object)));
2300 /* If OBJECT is not BLKmode and SIZE is the same size as its mode,
2301 just move a zero. Otherwise, do this a piece at a time. */
2302 if (GET_MODE (object) != BLKmode
2303 && GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
2304 && INTVAL (size) == (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (object)))
2305 emit_move_insn (object, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (object)));
2306 else
2308 if (size == const0_rtx)
2310 else if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
2311 && CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
2312 clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
2313 else if (clear_storage_via_clrmem (object, size, align))
2315 else
2316 retval = clear_storage_via_libcall (object, size);
2319 return retval;
2322 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a clrmem pattern;
2323 return true if successful. */
2325 static bool
2326 clear_storage_via_clrmem (rtx object, rtx size, unsigned int align)
2328 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
2329 including more than one in the machine description unless
2330 the more limited one has some advantage. */
2332 rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2333 enum machine_mode mode;
2335 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
2336 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2338 enum insn_code code = clrmem_optab[(int) mode];
2339 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
2341 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
2342 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than
2343 BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT here because if SIZE is less than
2344 the mode mask, as it is returned by the macro, it will
2345 definitely be less than the actual mode mask. */
2346 && ((GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
2347 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
2348 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
2349 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
2350 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate) == 0
2351 || (*pred) (object, BLKmode))
2352 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate) == 0
2353 || (*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode)))
2355 rtx op1;
2356 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
2357 rtx pat;
2359 op1 = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
2360 pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate;
2361 if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (op1, mode))
2362 op1 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op1);
2364 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (object, op1, opalign);
2365 if (pat)
2367 emit_insn (pat);
2368 return true;
2370 else
2371 delete_insns_since (last);
2375 return false;
2378 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a call to memset.
2379 Return the return value of memset, 0 otherwise. */
2381 static rtx
2382 clear_storage_via_libcall (rtx object, rtx size)
2384 tree call_expr, arg_list, fn, object_tree, size_tree;
2385 enum machine_mode size_mode;
2386 rtx retval;
2388 /* Emit code to copy OBJECT and SIZE into new pseudos. We can then
2389 place those into new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and use them later. */
2391 object = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (object, 0));
2393 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
2394 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
2395 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
2397 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
2398 memset in this context. This could be a user call to memset and
2399 the user may wish to examine the return value from memset. For
2400 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
2401 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
2403 object_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, object);
2404 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
2406 fn = clear_storage_libcall_fn (true);
2407 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, size_tree, NULL_TREE);
2408 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_zero_node, arg_list);
2409 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, object_tree, arg_list);
2411 /* Now we have to build up the CALL_EXPR itself. */
2412 call_expr = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fn)), fn);
2413 call_expr = build3 (CALL_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fn)),
2414 call_expr, arg_list, NULL_TREE);
2416 retval = expand_expr (call_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
2418 return retval;
2421 /* A subroutine of clear_storage_via_libcall. Create the tree node
2422 for the function we use for block clears. The first time FOR_CALL
2423 is true, we call assemble_external. */
2425 static GTY(()) tree block_clear_fn;
2427 void
2428 init_block_clear_fn (const char *asmspec)
2430 if (!block_clear_fn)
2432 tree fn, args;
2434 fn = get_identifier ("memset");
2435 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
2436 integer_type_node, sizetype,
2437 NULL_TREE);
2439 fn = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
2440 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
2441 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
2442 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
2443 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
2445 block_clear_fn = fn;
2448 if (asmspec)
2449 set_user_assembler_name (block_clear_fn, asmspec);
2452 static tree
2453 clear_storage_libcall_fn (int for_call)
2455 static bool emitted_extern;
2457 if (!block_clear_fn)
2458 init_block_clear_fn (NULL);
2460 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
2462 emitted_extern = true;
2463 make_decl_rtl (block_clear_fn);
2464 assemble_external (block_clear_fn);
2467 return block_clear_fn;
2470 /* Generate code to copy Y into X.
2471 Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
2472 Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
2473 This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
2475 Return the last instruction emitted. */
2478 emit_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
2480 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
2481 rtx y_cst = NULL_RTX;
2482 rtx last_insn, set;
2484 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode
2485 && (GET_MODE (y) == mode || GET_MODE (y) == VOIDmode));
2487 if (CONSTANT_P (y))
2489 if (optimize
2490 && SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
2491 && (last_insn = compress_float_constant (x, y)))
2492 return last_insn;
2494 y_cst = y;
2496 if (!LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (y))
2498 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
2500 /* If the target's cannot_force_const_mem prevented the spill,
2501 assume that the target's move expanders will also take care
2502 of the non-legitimate constant. */
2503 if (!y)
2504 y = y_cst;
2508 /* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
2509 for the machine. */
2510 if (MEM_P (x)
2511 && ((! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0))
2512 && ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
2513 || (flag_force_addr
2514 && CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (x, 0)))))
2515 x = validize_mem (x);
2517 if (MEM_P (y)
2518 && (! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0))
2519 || (flag_force_addr
2520 && CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (y, 0)))))
2521 y = validize_mem (y);
2523 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
2525 last_insn = emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
2527 if (y_cst && REG_P (x)
2528 && (set = single_set (last_insn)) != NULL_RTX
2529 && SET_DEST (set) == x
2530 && ! rtx_equal_p (y_cst, SET_SRC (set)))
2531 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y_cst);
2533 return last_insn;
2536 /* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
2537 Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
2538 are basically valid. */
2541 emit_move_insn_1 (rtx x, rtx y)
2543 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
2544 enum machine_mode submode;
2545 enum mode_class class = GET_MODE_CLASS (mode);
2547 gcc_assert ((unsigned int) mode < (unsigned int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE);
2549 if (mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
2550 return
2551 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code) (x, y));
2553 /* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part, if possible. */
2554 else if ((class == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT || class == MODE_COMPLEX_INT)
2555 && BLKmode != (submode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode))
2556 && (mov_optab->handlers[(int) submode].insn_code
2557 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
2559 /* Don't split destination if it is a stack push. */
2560 int stack = push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x));
2562 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
2563 /* In case we output to the stack, but the size is smaller than the
2564 machine can push exactly, we need to use move instructions. */
2565 if (stack
2566 && (PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (submode))
2567 != GET_MODE_SIZE (submode)))
2569 rtx temp;
2570 HOST_WIDE_INT offset1, offset2;
2572 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
2573 stack_pointer_delta. */
2574 temp = expand_binop (Pmode,
2575 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2576 sub_optab,
2577 #else
2578 add_optab,
2579 #endif
2580 stack_pointer_rtx,
2581 GEN_INT
2582 (PUSH_ROUNDING
2583 (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)))),
2584 stack_pointer_rtx, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
2586 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
2587 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
2589 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2590 offset1 = 0;
2591 offset2 = GET_MODE_SIZE (submode);
2592 #else
2593 offset1 = -PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
2594 offset2 = (-PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)))
2595 + GET_MODE_SIZE (submode));
2596 #endif
2598 emit_move_insn (change_address (x, submode,
2599 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
2600 stack_pointer_rtx,
2601 GEN_INT (offset1))),
2602 gen_realpart (submode, y));
2603 emit_move_insn (change_address (x, submode,
2604 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
2605 stack_pointer_rtx,
2606 GEN_INT (offset2))),
2607 gen_imagpart (submode, y));
2609 else
2610 #endif
2611 /* If this is a stack, push the highpart first, so it
2612 will be in the argument order.
2614 In that case, change_address is used only to convert
2615 the mode, not to change the address. */
2616 if (stack)
2618 /* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
2619 regardless of machine's endianness. */
2620 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2621 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
2622 gen_imagpart (submode, y));
2623 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
2624 gen_realpart (submode, y));
2625 #else
2626 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
2627 gen_realpart (submode, y));
2628 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
2629 gen_imagpart (submode, y));
2630 #endif
2632 else
2634 rtx realpart_x, realpart_y;
2635 rtx imagpart_x, imagpart_y;
2637 /* If this is a complex value with each part being smaller than a
2638 word, the usual calling sequence will likely pack the pieces into
2639 a single register. Unfortunately, SUBREG of hard registers only
2640 deals in terms of words, so we have a problem converting input
2641 arguments to the CONCAT of two registers that is used elsewhere
2642 for complex values. If this is before reload, we can copy it into
2643 memory and reload. FIXME, we should see about using extract and
2644 insert on integer registers, but complex short and complex char
2645 variables should be rarely used. */
2646 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < 2 * BITS_PER_WORD
2647 && (reload_in_progress | reload_completed) == 0)
2649 int packed_dest_p
2650 = (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2651 int packed_src_p
2652 = (REG_P (y) && REGNO (y) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2654 if (packed_dest_p || packed_src_p)
2656 enum mode_class reg_class = ((class == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
2657 ? MODE_FLOAT : MODE_INT);
2659 enum machine_mode reg_mode
2660 = mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), reg_class, 1);
2662 if (reg_mode != BLKmode)
2664 rtx mem = assign_stack_temp (reg_mode,
2665 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
2666 rtx cmem = adjust_address (mem, mode, 0);
2668 if (packed_dest_p)
2670 rtx sreg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (reg_mode, x, 0);
2672 emit_move_insn_1 (cmem, y);
2673 return emit_move_insn_1 (sreg, mem);
2675 else
2677 rtx sreg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (reg_mode, y, 0);
2679 emit_move_insn_1 (mem, sreg);
2680 return emit_move_insn_1 (x, cmem);
2686 realpart_x = gen_realpart (submode, x);
2687 realpart_y = gen_realpart (submode, y);
2688 imagpart_x = gen_imagpart (submode, x);
2689 imagpart_y = gen_imagpart (submode, y);
2691 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
2692 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
2693 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
2694 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
2695 if (x != y
2696 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
2697 && (GET_CODE (realpart_x) == SUBREG
2698 || GET_CODE (imagpart_x) == SUBREG))
2699 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, x));
2701 emit_move_insn (realpart_x, realpart_y);
2702 emit_move_insn (imagpart_x, imagpart_y);
2705 return get_last_insn ();
2708 /* Handle MODE_CC modes: If we don't have a special move insn for this mode,
2709 find a mode to do it in. If we have a movcc, use it. Otherwise,
2710 find the MODE_INT mode of the same width. */
2711 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC
2712 && mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
2714 enum insn_code insn_code;
2715 enum machine_mode tmode = VOIDmode;
2716 rtx x1 = x, y1 = y;
2718 if (mode != CCmode
2719 && mov_optab->handlers[(int) CCmode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
2720 tmode = CCmode;
2721 else
2722 for (tmode = QImode; tmode != VOIDmode;
2723 tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2724 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2725 break;
2727 gcc_assert (tmode != VOIDmode);
2729 /* Get X and Y in TMODE. We can't use gen_lowpart here because it
2730 may call change_address which is not appropriate if we were
2731 called when a reload was in progress. We don't have to worry
2732 about changing the address since the size in bytes is supposed to
2733 be the same. Copy the MEM to change the mode and move any
2734 substitutions from the old MEM to the new one. */
2736 if (reload_in_progress)
2738 x = gen_lowpart_common (tmode, x1);
2739 if (x == 0 && MEM_P (x1))
2741 x = adjust_address_nv (x1, tmode, 0);
2742 copy_replacements (x1, x);
2745 y = gen_lowpart_common (tmode, y1);
2746 if (y == 0 && MEM_P (y1))
2748 y = adjust_address_nv (y1, tmode, 0);
2749 copy_replacements (y1, y);
2752 else
2754 x = gen_lowpart (tmode, x);
2755 y = gen_lowpart (tmode, y);
2758 insn_code = mov_optab->handlers[(int) tmode].insn_code;
2759 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (insn_code) (x, y));
2762 /* Try using a move pattern for the corresponding integer mode. This is
2763 only safe when simplify_subreg can convert MODE constants into integer
2764 constants. At present, it can only do this reliably if the value
2765 fits within a HOST_WIDE_INT. */
2766 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
2767 && (submode = int_mode_for_mode (mode)) != BLKmode
2768 && mov_optab->handlers[submode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
2769 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (mov_optab->handlers[submode].insn_code)
2770 (simplify_gen_subreg (submode, x, mode, 0),
2771 simplify_gen_subreg (submode, y, mode, 0)));
2773 /* This will handle any multi-word or full-word mode that lacks a move_insn
2774 pattern. However, you will get better code if you define such patterns,
2775 even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
2776 else
2778 rtx last_insn = 0;
2779 rtx seq, inner;
2780 int need_clobber;
2781 int i;
2783 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= UNITS_PER_WORD);
2785 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
2787 /* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
2788 X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
2789 if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
2791 rtx temp;
2792 enum rtx_code code;
2794 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
2795 stack_pointer_delta. */
2796 temp = expand_binop (Pmode,
2797 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2798 sub_optab,
2799 #else
2800 add_optab,
2801 #endif
2802 stack_pointer_rtx,
2803 GEN_INT
2804 (PUSH_ROUNDING
2805 (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)))),
2806 stack_pointer_rtx, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
2808 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
2809 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
2811 code = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
2813 /* Just hope that small offsets off SP are OK. */
2814 if (code == POST_INC)
2815 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
2816 GEN_INT (-((HOST_WIDE_INT)
2817 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)))));
2818 else if (code == POST_DEC)
2819 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
2820 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))));
2821 else
2822 temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
2824 x = change_address (x, VOIDmode, temp);
2826 #endif
2828 /* If we are in reload, see if either operand is a MEM whose address
2829 is scheduled for replacement. */
2830 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (x)
2831 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (x, 0))) != XEXP (x, 0))
2832 x = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, inner);
2833 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (y)
2834 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (y, 0))) != XEXP (y, 0))
2835 y = replace_equiv_address_nv (y, inner);
2837 start_sequence ();
2839 need_clobber = 0;
2840 for (i = 0;
2841 i < (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
2842 i++)
2844 rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
2845 rtx ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
2847 /* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
2848 constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. If we still
2849 can't get a part of Y, abort. */
2850 if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
2852 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
2853 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
2855 else if (ypart == 0)
2856 ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
2858 gcc_assert (xpart && ypart);
2860 need_clobber |= (GET_CODE (xpart) == SUBREG);
2862 last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
2865 seq = get_insns ();
2866 end_sequence ();
2868 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
2869 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
2870 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
2871 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
2872 if (x != y
2873 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
2874 && need_clobber != 0)
2875 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, x));
2877 emit_insn (seq);
2879 return last_insn;
2883 /* If Y is representable exactly in a narrower mode, and the target can
2884 perform the extension directly from constant or memory, then emit the
2885 move as an extension. */
2887 static rtx
2888 compress_float_constant (rtx x, rtx y)
2890 enum machine_mode dstmode = GET_MODE (x);
2891 enum machine_mode orig_srcmode = GET_MODE (y);
2892 enum machine_mode srcmode;
2893 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
2895 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, y);
2897 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (GET_MODE_CLASS (orig_srcmode));
2898 srcmode != orig_srcmode;
2899 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
2901 enum insn_code ic;
2902 rtx trunc_y, last_insn;
2904 /* Skip if the target can't extend this way. */
2905 ic = can_extend_p (dstmode, srcmode, 0);
2906 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
2907 continue;
2909 /* Skip if the narrowed value isn't exact. */
2910 if (! exact_real_truncate (srcmode, &r))
2911 continue;
2913 trunc_y = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (r, srcmode);
2915 if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (trunc_y))
2917 /* Skip if the target needs extra instructions to perform
2918 the extension. */
2919 if (! (*insn_data[ic].operand[1].predicate) (trunc_y, srcmode))
2920 continue;
2922 else if (float_extend_from_mem[dstmode][srcmode])
2923 trunc_y = validize_mem (force_const_mem (srcmode, trunc_y));
2924 else
2925 continue;
2927 emit_unop_insn (ic, x, trunc_y, UNKNOWN);
2928 last_insn = get_last_insn ();
2930 if (REG_P (x))
2931 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y);
2933 return last_insn;
2936 return NULL_RTX;
2939 /* Pushing data onto the stack. */
2941 /* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
2942 and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
2943 The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
2945 EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
2946 BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
2947 otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
2950 push_block (rtx size, int extra, int below)
2952 rtx temp;
2954 size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
2955 if (CONSTANT_P (size))
2956 anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (size, extra));
2957 else if (REG_P (size) && extra == 0)
2958 anti_adjust_stack (size);
2959 else
2961 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
2962 if (extra != 0)
2963 temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (extra),
2964 temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
2965 anti_adjust_stack (temp);
2968 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2969 if (0)
2970 #else
2971 if (1)
2972 #endif
2974 temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
2975 if (extra != 0 && below)
2976 temp = plus_constant (temp, extra);
2978 else
2980 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
2981 temp = plus_constant (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
2982 -INTVAL (size) - (below ? 0 : extra));
2983 else if (extra != 0 && !below)
2984 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
2985 negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (size, extra)));
2986 else
2987 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
2988 negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
2991 return memory_address (GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), temp);
2994 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
2996 /* Emit single push insn. */
2998 static void
2999 emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
3001 rtx dest_addr;
3002 unsigned rounded_size = PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3003 rtx dest;
3004 enum insn_code icode;
3005 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
3007 stack_pointer_delta += PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3008 /* If there is push pattern, use it. Otherwise try old way of throwing
3009 MEM representing push operation to move expander. */
3010 icode = push_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
3011 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3013 if (((pred = insn_data[(int) icode].operand[0].predicate)
3014 && !((*pred) (x, mode))))
3015 x = force_reg (mode, x);
3016 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (x));
3017 return;
3019 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == rounded_size)
3020 dest_addr = gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
3021 /* If we are to pad downward, adjust the stack pointer first and
3022 then store X into the stack location using an offset. This is
3023 because emit_move_insn does not know how to pad; it does not have
3024 access to type. */
3025 else if (FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type) == downward)
3027 unsigned padding_size = rounded_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3028 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
3030 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
3031 expand_binop (Pmode,
3032 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3033 sub_optab,
3034 #else
3035 add_optab,
3036 #endif
3037 stack_pointer_rtx,
3038 GEN_INT (rounded_size),
3039 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
3041 offset = (HOST_WIDE_INT) padding_size;
3042 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3043 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
3044 /* We have already decremented the stack pointer, so get the
3045 previous value. */
3046 offset += (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3047 #else
3048 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
3049 /* We have already incremented the stack pointer, so get the
3050 previous value. */
3051 offset -= (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3052 #endif
3053 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (offset));
3055 else
3057 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3058 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC. */
3059 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3060 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size));
3061 #else
3062 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC. */
3063 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3064 GEN_INT (rounded_size));
3065 #endif
3066 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PRE_MODIFY (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, dest_addr);
3069 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, dest_addr);
3071 if (type != 0)
3073 set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
3075 if (flag_optimize_sibling_calls)
3076 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
3077 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
3078 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
3079 of sibling calls. */
3080 set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
3082 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
3084 #endif
3086 /* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
3087 type TYPE.
3088 MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
3089 carry mode info).
3090 SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
3091 needed only if X is BLKmode.
3093 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume.
3095 If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
3096 words of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
3097 The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL words,
3098 rounded *down* to a multiple of PARM_BOUNDARY.
3099 REG must be a hard register in this case.
3100 If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
3101 argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
3102 registers.
3104 EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
3105 This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
3107 On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
3108 the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
3109 to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
3110 argument block has not been preallocated.
3112 ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
3114 REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
3115 for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
3116 of bytes required. */
3118 void
3119 emit_push_insn (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, tree type, rtx size,
3120 unsigned int align, int partial, rtx reg, int extra,
3121 rtx args_addr, rtx args_so_far, int reg_parm_stack_space,
3122 rtx alignment_pad)
3124 rtx xinner;
3125 enum direction stack_direction
3126 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3127 = downward;
3128 #else
3129 = upward;
3130 #endif
3132 /* Decide where to pad the argument: `downward' for below,
3133 `upward' for above, or `none' for don't pad it.
3134 Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
3135 enum direction where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type);
3137 /* Invert direction if stack is post-decrement.
3138 FIXME: why? */
3139 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
3140 if (where_pad != none)
3141 where_pad = (where_pad == downward ? upward : downward);
3143 xinner = x;
3145 if (mode == BLKmode)
3147 /* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
3149 rtx temp;
3150 int used = partial * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3151 int offset;
3152 int skip;
3154 if (reg && GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
3156 /* Use the size of the elt to compute offset. */
3157 rtx elt = XEXP (XVECEXP (reg, 0, 0), 0);
3158 used = partial * GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elt));
3159 offset = used % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3161 else
3162 offset = used % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3164 gcc_assert (size);
3166 used -= offset;
3168 /* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
3169 because registers will take care of them. */
3171 if (partial != 0)
3172 xinner = adjust_address (xinner, BLKmode, used);
3174 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
3175 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
3176 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
3177 by setting SKIP to 0. */
3178 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
3180 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3181 /* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
3182 and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
3183 on the stack for alignment purposes. */
3184 if (args_addr == 0
3185 && PUSH_ARGS
3186 && GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
3187 && skip == 0
3188 && MEM_ALIGN (xinner) >= align
3189 && (MOVE_BY_PIECES_P ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align))
3190 /* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
3191 forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
3192 and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
3193 && ((! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align))
3194 || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
3195 || (PUSH_ROUNDING (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
3196 == (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)))
3197 && PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)) == INTVAL (size))
3199 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
3200 or if padding below and stack grows up.
3201 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
3202 if (extra && args_addr == 0
3203 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
3204 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3206 move_by_pieces (NULL, xinner, INTVAL (size) - used, align, 0);
3208 else
3209 #endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
3211 rtx target;
3213 /* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
3214 to the address of that space. */
3216 /* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
3217 if (partial != 0)
3219 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
3220 size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
3221 else
3222 size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
3223 GEN_INT (used), NULL_RTX, 0,
3224 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3227 /* Get the address of the stack space.
3228 In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
3229 A single stack adjust will do. */
3230 if (! args_addr)
3232 temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == downward);
3233 extra = 0;
3235 else if (GET_CODE (args_so_far) == CONST_INT)
3236 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
3237 plus_constant (args_addr,
3238 skip + INTVAL (args_so_far)));
3239 else
3240 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
3241 plus_constant (gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
3242 args_addr,
3243 args_so_far),
3244 skip));
3246 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
3248 /* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
3249 copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
3250 to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
3252 if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
3253 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
3254 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
3257 target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
3259 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
3260 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
3261 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
3262 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
3263 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
3264 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
3265 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
3266 set_mem_align (target, align);
3268 emit_block_move (target, xinner, size, BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM);
3271 else if (partial > 0)
3273 /* Scalar partly in registers. */
3275 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3276 int i;
3277 int not_stack;
3278 /* # words of start of argument
3279 that we must make space for but need not store. */
3280 int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_WORD);
3281 int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
3282 int skip;
3284 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
3285 or if padding below and stack grows up.
3286 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
3287 if (extra && args_addr == 0
3288 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
3289 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3291 /* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
3292 the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
3293 and leave the space uninitialized. */
3294 if (args_addr == 0)
3295 offset = 0;
3297 /* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
3298 allocate on the stack. */
3299 not_stack = partial - offset;
3301 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
3302 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
3303 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
3304 by setting SKIP to 0. */
3305 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
3307 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
3308 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
3310 /* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
3311 SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
3312 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3313 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
3314 x = copy_to_reg (x);
3316 /* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
3317 /* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
3318 has a size a multiple of a word. */
3319 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3320 for (i = not_stack; i < size; i++)
3321 #else
3322 for (i = size - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
3323 #endif
3324 if (i >= not_stack + offset)
3325 emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
3326 word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
3327 0, args_addr,
3328 GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
3329 * UNITS_PER_WORD)),
3330 reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad);
3332 else
3334 rtx addr;
3335 rtx dest;
3337 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
3338 or if padding below and stack grows up.
3339 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
3340 if (extra && args_addr == 0
3341 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
3342 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3344 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3345 if (args_addr == 0 && PUSH_ARGS)
3346 emit_single_push_insn (mode, x, type);
3347 else
3348 #endif
3350 if (GET_CODE (args_so_far) == CONST_INT)
3351 addr
3352 = memory_address (mode,
3353 plus_constant (args_addr,
3354 INTVAL (args_so_far)));
3355 else
3356 addr = memory_address (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, args_addr,
3357 args_so_far));
3358 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
3360 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
3361 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
3362 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
3363 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
3364 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
3365 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
3366 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
3367 set_mem_align (dest, align);
3369 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
3373 /* If part should go in registers, copy that part
3374 into the appropriate registers. Do this now, at the end,
3375 since mem-to-mem copies above may do function calls. */
3376 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
3378 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
3379 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
3380 if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
3381 emit_group_load (reg, x, type, -1);
3382 else
3383 move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, partial, mode);
3386 if (extra && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
3387 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3389 if (alignment_pad && args_addr == 0)
3390 anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
3393 /* Return X if X can be used as a subtarget in a sequence of arithmetic
3394 operations. */
3396 static rtx
3397 get_subtarget (rtx x)
3399 return (optimize
3400 || x == 0
3401 /* Only registers can be subtargets. */
3402 || !REG_P (x)
3403 /* Don't use hard regs to avoid extending their life. */
3404 || REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3405 ? 0 : x);
3408 /* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO.
3409 If WANT_VALUE is nonzero, return an rtx for the value of TO.
3410 (If the value is constant, this rtx is a constant.)
3411 Otherwise, the returned value is NULL_RTX. */
3414 expand_assignment (tree to, tree from, int want_value)
3416 rtx to_rtx = 0;
3417 rtx result;
3419 /* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
3421 if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
3423 result = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
3424 return want_value ? result : NULL_RTX;
3427 /* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
3428 if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
3429 Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
3430 an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
3431 problem. */
3433 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF || TREE_CODE (to) == BIT_FIELD_REF
3434 || TREE_CODE (to) == ARRAY_REF || TREE_CODE (to) == ARRAY_RANGE_REF
3435 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3437 enum machine_mode mode1;
3438 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
3439 rtx orig_to_rtx;
3440 tree offset;
3441 int unsignedp;
3442 int volatilep = 0;
3443 tree tem;
3445 push_temp_slots ();
3446 tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
3447 &unsignedp, &volatilep);
3449 /* If we are going to use store_bit_field and extract_bit_field,
3450 make sure to_rtx will be safe for multiple use. */
3452 if (mode1 == VOIDmode && want_value)
3453 tem = stabilize_reference (tem);
3455 orig_to_rtx = to_rtx = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
3457 if (offset != 0)
3459 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
3461 gcc_assert (MEM_P (to_rtx));
3463 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
3464 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != Pmode)
3465 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, offset_rtx, 0);
3466 #else
3467 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
3468 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
3469 #endif
3471 /* A constant address in TO_RTX can have VOIDmode, we must not try
3472 to call force_reg for that case. Avoid that case. */
3473 if (MEM_P (to_rtx)
3474 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode
3475 && GET_MODE (XEXP (to_rtx, 0)) != VOIDmode
3476 && bitsize > 0
3477 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
3478 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
3479 && MEM_ALIGN (to_rtx) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
3481 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3482 bitpos = 0;
3485 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
3486 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (to,
3487 offset));
3490 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
3492 /* If the field is at offset zero, we could have been given the
3493 DECL_RTX of the parent struct. Don't munge it. */
3494 to_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (to_rtx);
3496 set_mem_attributes_minus_bitpos (to_rtx, to, 0, bitpos);
3499 /* Deal with volatile and readonly fields. The former is only done
3500 for MEM. Also set MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P if needed. */
3501 if (volatilep && MEM_P (to_rtx))
3503 if (to_rtx == orig_to_rtx)
3504 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
3505 MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
3508 if (MEM_P (to_rtx) && ! can_address_p (to))
3510 if (to_rtx == orig_to_rtx)
3511 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
3512 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
3515 /* Optimize bitfld op= val in certain cases. */
3516 while (mode1 == VOIDmode && !want_value
3517 && bitsize > 0 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
3518 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx)) <= BITS_PER_WORD
3519 && !TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (to)
3520 && !TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (to))
3522 tree src, op0, op1;
3523 rtx value, str_rtx = to_rtx;
3524 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos1 = bitpos;
3525 optab binop;
3527 src = from;
3528 STRIP_NOPS (src);
3529 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) != INTEGER_TYPE
3530 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (src)) != '2')
3531 break;
3533 op0 = TREE_OPERAND (src, 0);
3534 op1 = TREE_OPERAND (src, 1);
3535 STRIP_NOPS (op0);
3537 if (! operand_equal_p (to, op0, 0))
3538 break;
3540 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
3542 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (str_rtx);
3543 HOST_WIDE_INT offset1;
3545 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == 0
3546 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
3547 mode = word_mode;
3548 mode = get_best_mode (bitsize, bitpos1, MEM_ALIGN (str_rtx),
3549 mode, 0);
3550 if (mode == VOIDmode)
3551 break;
3553 offset1 = bitpos1;
3554 bitpos1 %= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
3555 offset1 = (offset1 - bitpos1) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
3556 str_rtx = adjust_address (str_rtx, mode, offset1);
3558 else if (!REG_P (str_rtx) && GET_CODE (str_rtx) != SUBREG)
3559 break;
3561 /* If the bit field covers the whole REG/MEM, store_field
3562 will likely generate better code. */
3563 if (bitsize >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (str_rtx)))
3564 break;
3566 /* We can't handle fields split across multiple entities. */
3567 if (bitpos1 + bitsize > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (str_rtx)))
3568 break;
3570 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
3571 bitpos1 = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (str_rtx)) - bitpos1
3572 - bitsize;
3574 /* Special case some bitfield op= exp. */
3575 switch (TREE_CODE (src))
3577 case PLUS_EXPR:
3578 case MINUS_EXPR:
3579 /* For now, just optimize the case of the topmost bitfield
3580 where we don't need to do any masking and also
3581 1 bit bitfields where xor can be used.
3582 We might win by one instruction for the other bitfields
3583 too if insv/extv instructions aren't used, so that
3584 can be added later. */
3585 if (bitpos1 + bitsize != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (str_rtx))
3586 && (bitsize != 1 || TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST))
3587 break;
3588 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (str_rtx), 0);
3589 value = convert_modes (GET_MODE (str_rtx),
3590 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
3591 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
3593 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
3594 we can alias adjacent data. */
3595 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
3597 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
3598 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
3599 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
3602 binop = TREE_CODE (src) == PLUS_EXPR ? add_optab : sub_optab;
3603 if (bitsize == 1
3604 && bitpos1 + bitsize != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (str_rtx)))
3606 value = expand_and (GET_MODE (str_rtx), value, const1_rtx,
3607 NULL_RTX);
3608 binop = xor_optab;
3610 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (str_rtx), value,
3611 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, bitpos1),
3612 NULL_RTX, 1);
3613 result = expand_binop (GET_MODE (str_rtx), binop, str_rtx,
3614 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3615 if (result != str_rtx)
3616 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
3617 free_temp_slots ();
3618 pop_temp_slots ();
3619 return NULL_RTX;
3621 default:
3622 break;
3625 break;
3628 result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode1, from,
3629 (want_value
3630 /* Spurious cast for HPUX compiler. */
3631 ? ((enum machine_mode)
3632 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to)))
3633 : VOIDmode),
3634 unsignedp, TREE_TYPE (tem), get_alias_set (to));
3636 preserve_temp_slots (result);
3637 free_temp_slots ();
3638 pop_temp_slots ();
3640 /* If the value is meaningful, convert RESULT to the proper mode.
3641 Otherwise, return nothing. */
3642 return (want_value ? convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to)),
3643 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)),
3644 result,
3645 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (to)))
3646 : NULL_RTX);
3649 /* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
3650 call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
3651 This is needed for correct code for cases such as
3652 val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
3653 requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
3655 Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL or PARM_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG
3656 since it might be a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension
3657 needs to be done. Handling this in the normal way is safe because no
3658 computation is done before the call. */
3659 if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from, from)
3660 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
3661 && ! ((TREE_CODE (to) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (to) == PARM_DECL)
3662 && REG_P (DECL_RTL (to))))
3664 rtx value;
3666 push_temp_slots ();
3667 value = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
3668 if (to_rtx == 0)
3669 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
3671 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
3672 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
3673 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
3674 emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
3675 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
3676 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
3677 emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
3678 else
3680 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (to)))
3681 value = convert_memory_address (GET_MODE (to_rtx), value);
3682 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
3684 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
3685 free_temp_slots ();
3686 pop_temp_slots ();
3687 return want_value ? to_rtx : NULL_RTX;
3690 /* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx.
3691 Don't re-expand if it was expanded already (in COMPONENT_REF case). */
3693 if (to_rtx == 0)
3694 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
3696 /* Don't move directly into a return register. */
3697 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
3698 && (REG_P (to_rtx) || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
3700 rtx temp;
3702 push_temp_slots ();
3703 temp = expand_expr (from, 0, GET_MODE (to_rtx), 0);
3705 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
3706 emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, TREE_TYPE (from),
3707 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
3708 else
3709 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
3711 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
3712 free_temp_slots ();
3713 pop_temp_slots ();
3714 return want_value ? to_rtx : NULL_RTX;
3717 /* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
3718 the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
3719 a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
3720 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
3721 && current_function_returns_struct
3722 && !current_function_returns_pcc_struct)
3724 rtx from_rtx, size;
3726 push_temp_slots ();
3727 size = expr_size (from);
3728 from_rtx = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
3730 emit_library_call (memmove_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
3731 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
3732 XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
3733 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
3734 size, TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
3735 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
3737 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
3738 free_temp_slots ();
3739 pop_temp_slots ();
3740 return want_value ? to_rtx : NULL_RTX;
3743 /* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
3745 push_temp_slots ();
3746 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, want_value);
3747 preserve_temp_slots (result);
3748 free_temp_slots ();
3749 pop_temp_slots ();
3750 return want_value ? result : NULL_RTX;
3753 /* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
3754 and storing the value into TARGET.
3756 If WANT_VALUE & 1 is nonzero, return a copy of the value
3757 not in TARGET, so that we can be sure to use the proper
3758 value in a containing expression even if TARGET has something
3759 else stored in it. If possible, we copy the value through a pseudo
3760 and return that pseudo. Or, if the value is constant, we try to
3761 return the constant. In some cases, we return a pseudo
3762 copied *from* TARGET.
3764 If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
3765 It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
3766 because C has no operators that could combine two different
3767 assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
3768 with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
3769 be more thorough?
3771 If WANT_VALUE & 1 is 0, we return NULL, to make sure
3772 to catch quickly any cases where the caller uses the value
3773 and fails to set WANT_VALUE.
3775 If WANT_VALUE & 2 is set, this is a store into a call param on the
3776 stack, and block moves may need to be treated specially. */
3779 store_expr (tree exp, rtx target, int want_value)
3781 rtx temp;
3782 rtx alt_rtl = NULL_RTX;
3783 int dont_return_target = 0;
3784 int dont_store_target = 0;
3786 if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
3788 /* C++ can generate ?: expressions with a throw expression in one
3789 branch and an rvalue in the other. Here, we resolve attempts to
3790 store the throw expression's nonexistent result. */
3791 gcc_assert (!want_value);
3792 expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
3793 return NULL_RTX;
3795 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
3797 /* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
3798 part. */
3799 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
3800 want_value & 2 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
3801 return store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, want_value);
3803 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
3805 /* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
3806 test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
3807 side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
3808 For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
3810 rtx lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
3812 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
3813 NO_DEFER_POP;
3814 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1);
3815 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, want_value & 2);
3816 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (lab2));
3817 emit_barrier ();
3818 emit_label (lab1);
3819 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, want_value & 2);
3820 emit_label (lab2);
3821 OK_DEFER_POP;
3823 return want_value & 1 ? target : NULL_RTX;
3825 else if ((want_value & 1) != 0
3826 && MEM_P (target)
3827 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (target)
3828 && GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode)
3829 /* If target is in memory and caller wants value in a register instead,
3830 arrange that. Pass TARGET as target for expand_expr so that,
3831 if EXP is another assignment, WANT_VALUE will be nonzero for it.
3832 We know expand_expr will not use the target in that case.
3833 Don't do this if TARGET is volatile because we are supposed
3834 to write it and then read it. */
3836 temp = expand_expr (exp, target, GET_MODE (target),
3837 want_value & 2 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
3838 if (GET_MODE (temp) != BLKmode && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
3840 /* If TEMP is already in the desired TARGET, only copy it from
3841 memory and don't store it there again. */
3842 if (temp == target
3843 || (rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
3844 && ! side_effects_p (temp) && ! side_effects_p (target)))
3845 dont_store_target = 1;
3846 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
3848 dont_return_target = 1;
3850 else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
3851 /* If this is a scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
3852 than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
3853 and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
3854 expression. */
3856 rtx inner_target = 0;
3858 /* If we don't want a value, we can do the conversion inside EXP,
3859 which will often result in some optimizations. Do the conversion
3860 in two steps: first change the signedness, if needed, then
3861 the extend. But don't do this if the type of EXP is a subtype
3862 of something else since then the conversion might involve
3863 more than just converting modes. */
3864 if ((want_value & 1) == 0
3865 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
3866 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0
3867 && (!lang_hooks.reduce_bit_field_operations
3868 || (GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (target))
3869 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp)))))
3871 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))
3872 != SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target))
3873 exp = convert
3874 (lang_hooks.types.signed_or_unsigned_type
3875 (SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target), TREE_TYPE (exp)), exp);
3877 exp = convert (lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
3878 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
3879 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target)),
3880 exp);
3882 inner_target = SUBREG_REG (target);
3885 temp = expand_expr (exp, inner_target, VOIDmode,
3886 want_value & 2 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
3888 /* If TEMP is a MEM and we want a result value, make the access
3889 now so it gets done only once. Strictly speaking, this is
3890 only necessary if the MEM is volatile, or if the address
3891 overlaps TARGET. But not performing the load twice also
3892 reduces the amount of rtl we generate and then have to CSE. */
3893 if (MEM_P (temp) && (want_value & 1) != 0)
3894 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
3896 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
3897 sure that we properly convert it. */
3898 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
3900 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
3901 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
3902 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
3903 GET_MODE (target), temp,
3904 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
3907 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
3908 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
3910 /* If we promoted a constant, change the mode back down to match
3911 target. Otherwise, the caller might get confused by a result whose
3912 mode is larger than expected. */
3914 if ((want_value & 1) != 0 && GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target))
3916 if (GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
3918 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (GET_MODE (target), temp);
3919 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
3920 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp,
3921 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
3923 else
3924 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target),
3925 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
3926 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
3929 return want_value & 1 ? temp : NULL_RTX;
3931 else
3933 temp = expand_expr_real (exp, target, GET_MODE (target),
3934 (want_value & 2
3935 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL),
3936 &alt_rtl);
3937 /* Return TARGET if it's a specified hardware register.
3938 If TARGET is a volatile mem ref, either return TARGET
3939 or return a reg copied *from* TARGET; ANSI requires this.
3941 Otherwise, if TEMP is not TARGET, return TEMP
3942 if it is constant (for efficiency),
3943 or if we really want the correct value. */
3944 if (!(target && REG_P (target)
3945 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3946 && !(MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
3947 && ! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
3948 && (CONSTANT_P (temp) || (want_value & 1) != 0))
3949 dont_return_target = 1;
3952 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
3953 the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
3954 example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE and we want only a word-sized
3955 value. */
3956 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
3957 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
3958 && GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
3959 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
3960 temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
3962 /* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
3963 Convert the value to TARGET's type first if necessary and emit the
3964 pending incrementations that have been queued when expanding EXP.
3965 Note that we cannot emit the whole queue blindly because this will
3966 effectively disable the POST_INC optimization later.
3968 If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
3969 one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
3970 two cases:
3971 - expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
3972 another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
3973 to == .
3974 - expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
3975 happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
3976 by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
3977 We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
3978 of volatile memory references. */
3980 if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
3981 || (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
3982 || side_effects_p (target))))
3983 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
3984 && ! dont_store_target
3985 /* If store_expr stores a DECL whose DECL_RTL(exp) == TARGET,
3986 but TARGET is not valid memory reference, TEMP will differ
3987 from TARGET although it is really the same location. */
3988 && !(alt_rtl && rtx_equal_p (alt_rtl, target))
3989 /* If there's nothing to copy, don't bother. Don't call expr_size
3990 unless necessary, because some front-ends (C++) expr_size-hook
3991 aborts on objects that are not supposed to be bit-copied or
3992 bit-initialized. */
3993 && expr_size (exp) != const0_rtx)
3995 if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target)
3996 && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
3998 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
3999 if (dont_return_target)
4001 /* In this case, we will return TEMP,
4002 so make sure it has the proper mode.
4003 But don't forget to store the value into TARGET. */
4004 temp = convert_to_mode (GET_MODE (target), temp, unsignedp);
4005 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
4007 else
4008 convert_move (target, temp, unsignedp);
4011 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
4013 /* Handle copying a string constant into an array. The string
4014 constant may be shorter than the array. So copy just the string's
4015 actual length, and clear the rest. First get the size of the data
4016 type of the string, which is actually the size of the target. */
4017 rtx size = expr_size (exp);
4019 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
4020 && INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
4021 emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
4022 (want_value & 2
4023 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4024 else
4026 /* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
4027 tree copy_size
4028 = size_binop (MIN_EXPR,
4029 make_tree (sizetype, size),
4030 size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp)));
4031 rtx copy_size_rtx
4032 = expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
4033 (want_value & 2
4034 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
4035 rtx label = 0;
4037 /* Copy that much. */
4038 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, copy_size_rtx,
4039 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
4040 emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
4041 (want_value & 2
4042 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4044 /* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
4045 Do all calculations in ptr_mode. */
4046 if (GET_CODE (copy_size_rtx) == CONST_INT)
4048 size = plus_constant (size, -INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
4049 target = adjust_address (target, BLKmode,
4050 INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
4052 else
4054 size = expand_binop (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), sub_optab, size,
4055 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
4056 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
4058 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4059 if (GET_MODE (copy_size_rtx) != Pmode)
4060 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, copy_size_rtx,
4061 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
4062 #endif
4064 target = offset_address (target, copy_size_rtx,
4065 highest_pow2_factor (copy_size));
4066 label = gen_label_rtx ();
4067 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
4068 GET_MODE (size), 0, label);
4071 if (size != const0_rtx)
4072 clear_storage (target, size);
4074 if (label)
4075 emit_label (label);
4078 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4079 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4080 else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
4081 emit_group_load (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
4082 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
4083 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
4084 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
4085 (want_value & 2
4086 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4087 else
4089 temp = force_operand (temp, target);
4090 if (temp != target)
4091 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
4095 /* If we don't want a value, return NULL_RTX. */
4096 if ((want_value & 1) == 0)
4097 return NULL_RTX;
4099 /* If we are supposed to return TEMP, do so as long as it isn't a MEM.
4100 ??? The latter test doesn't seem to make sense. */
4101 else if (dont_return_target && !MEM_P (temp))
4102 return temp;
4104 /* Return TARGET itself if it is a hard register. */
4105 else if ((want_value & 1) != 0
4106 && GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode
4107 && ! (REG_P (target)
4108 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
4109 return copy_to_reg (target);
4111 else
4112 return target;
4115 /* Examine CTOR. Discover how many scalar fields are set to nonzero
4116 values and place it in *P_NZ_ELTS. Discover how many scalar fields
4117 are set to non-constant values and place it in *P_NC_ELTS. */
4119 static void
4120 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
4121 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nc_elts)
4123 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, nc_elts;
4124 tree list;
4126 nz_elts = 0;
4127 nc_elts = 0;
4129 for (list = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor); list; list = TREE_CHAIN (list))
4131 tree value = TREE_VALUE (list);
4132 tree purpose = TREE_PURPOSE (list);
4133 HOST_WIDE_INT mult;
4135 mult = 1;
4136 if (TREE_CODE (purpose) == RANGE_EXPR)
4138 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 0);
4139 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 1);
4141 if (host_integerp (lo_index, 1) && host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
4142 mult = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
4143 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
4146 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
4148 case CONSTRUCTOR:
4150 HOST_WIDE_INT nz = 0, nc = 0;
4151 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (value, &nz, &nc);
4152 nz_elts += mult * nz;
4153 nc_elts += mult * nc;
4155 break;
4157 case INTEGER_CST:
4158 case REAL_CST:
4159 if (!initializer_zerop (value))
4160 nz_elts += mult;
4161 break;
4162 case COMPLEX_CST:
4163 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_REALPART (value)))
4164 nz_elts += mult;
4165 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_IMAGPART (value)))
4166 nz_elts += mult;
4167 break;
4168 case VECTOR_CST:
4170 tree v;
4171 for (v = TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (value); v; v = TREE_CHAIN (v))
4172 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_VALUE (v)))
4173 nz_elts += mult;
4175 break;
4177 default:
4178 nz_elts += mult;
4179 if (!initializer_constant_valid_p (value, TREE_TYPE (value)))
4180 nc_elts += mult;
4181 break;
4185 *p_nz_elts += nz_elts;
4186 *p_nc_elts += nc_elts;
4189 void
4190 categorize_ctor_elements (tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
4191 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nc_elts)
4193 *p_nz_elts = 0;
4194 *p_nc_elts = 0;
4195 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (ctor, p_nz_elts, p_nc_elts);
4198 /* Count the number of scalars in TYPE. Return -1 on overflow or
4199 variable-sized. */
4201 HOST_WIDE_INT
4202 count_type_elements (tree type)
4204 const HOST_WIDE_INT max = ~((HOST_WIDE_INT)1 << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT-1));
4205 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
4207 case ARRAY_TYPE:
4209 tree telts = array_type_nelts (type);
4210 if (telts && host_integerp (telts, 1))
4212 HOST_WIDE_INT n = tree_low_cst (telts, 1) + 1;
4213 HOST_WIDE_INT m = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (type));
4214 if (n == 0)
4215 return 0;
4216 else if (max / n > m)
4217 return n * m;
4219 return -1;
4222 case RECORD_TYPE:
4224 HOST_WIDE_INT n = 0, t;
4225 tree f;
4227 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = TREE_CHAIN (f))
4228 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
4230 t = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f));
4231 if (t < 0)
4232 return -1;
4233 n += t;
4236 return n;
4239 case UNION_TYPE:
4240 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
4242 /* Ho hum. How in the world do we guess here? Clearly it isn't
4243 right to count the fields. Guess based on the number of words. */
4244 HOST_WIDE_INT n = int_size_in_bytes (type);
4245 if (n < 0)
4246 return -1;
4247 return n / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4250 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
4251 return 2;
4253 case VECTOR_TYPE:
4254 return TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
4256 case INTEGER_TYPE:
4257 case REAL_TYPE:
4258 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
4259 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
4260 case CHAR_TYPE:
4261 case POINTER_TYPE:
4262 case OFFSET_TYPE:
4263 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
4264 return 1;
4266 case VOID_TYPE:
4267 case METHOD_TYPE:
4268 case FILE_TYPE:
4269 case SET_TYPE:
4270 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
4271 case LANG_TYPE:
4272 default:
4273 gcc_unreachable ();
4277 /* Return 1 if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
4280 mostly_zeros_p (tree exp)
4282 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
4285 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, nc_elts, elts;
4287 /* If there are no ranges of true bits, it is all zero. */
4288 if (TREE_TYPE (exp) && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == SET_TYPE)
4289 return CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp) == NULL_TREE;
4291 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &nc_elts);
4292 elts = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (exp));
4294 return nz_elts < elts / 4;
4297 return initializer_zerop (exp);
4300 /* Helper function for store_constructor.
4301 TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
4302 TYPE is the type of the CONSTRUCTOR, not the element type.
4303 CLEARED is as for store_constructor.
4304 ALIAS_SET is the alias set to use for any stores.
4306 This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
4307 necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
4308 the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
4309 clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
4311 static void
4312 store_constructor_field (rtx target, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
4313 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, enum machine_mode mode,
4314 tree exp, tree type, int cleared, int alias_set)
4316 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
4317 /* We can only call store_constructor recursively if the size and
4318 bit position are on a byte boundary. */
4319 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
4320 && (bitsize > 0 && bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
4321 /* If we have a nonzero bitpos for a register target, then we just
4322 let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
4323 generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
4324 && (bitpos == 0 || MEM_P (target)))
4326 if (MEM_P (target))
4327 target
4328 = adjust_address (target,
4329 GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
4330 || 0 != (bitpos
4331 % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (target)))
4332 ? BLKmode : VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4335 /* Update the alias set, if required. */
4336 if (MEM_P (target) && ! MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
4337 && MEM_ALIAS_SET (target) != 0)
4339 target = copy_rtx (target);
4340 set_mem_alias_set (target, alias_set);
4343 store_constructor (exp, target, cleared, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4345 else
4346 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, VOIDmode, 0, type,
4347 alias_set);
4350 /* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
4351 TARGET is either a REG or a MEM; we know it cannot conflict, since
4352 safe_from_p has been called.
4353 CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd.
4354 SIZE is the number of bytes of TARGET we are allowed to modify: this
4355 may not be the same as the size of EXP if we are assigning to a field
4356 which has been packed to exclude padding bits. */
4358 static void
4359 store_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, int cleared, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
4361 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
4362 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
4363 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
4364 #endif
4366 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
4368 case RECORD_TYPE:
4369 case UNION_TYPE:
4370 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
4372 tree elt;
4374 /* If size is zero or the target is already cleared, do nothing. */
4375 if (size == 0 || cleared)
4376 cleared = 1;
4377 /* We either clear the aggregate or indicate the value is dead. */
4378 else if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
4379 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
4380 && ! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
4381 /* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
4383 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp));
4384 cleared = 1;
4387 /* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
4388 set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
4389 a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
4390 this probably loses. */
4391 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp)
4392 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
4394 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
4395 cleared = 1;
4398 /* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure or
4399 if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros, clear
4400 the whole structure first. Don't do this if TARGET is a
4401 register whose mode size isn't equal to SIZE since
4402 clear_storage can't handle this case. */
4403 else if (size > 0
4404 && ((list_length (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
4405 != fields_length (type))
4406 || mostly_zeros_p (exp))
4407 && (!REG_P (target)
4408 || ((HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target))
4409 == size)))
4411 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size));
4412 cleared = 1;
4415 if (! cleared)
4416 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, target));
4418 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
4419 corresponding field of TARGET. */
4421 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp); elt; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
4423 tree field = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
4424 tree value = TREE_VALUE (elt);
4425 enum machine_mode mode;
4426 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
4427 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos = 0;
4428 tree offset;
4429 rtx to_rtx = target;
4431 /* Just ignore missing fields. We cleared the whole
4432 structure, above, if any fields are missing. */
4433 if (field == 0)
4434 continue;
4436 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
4437 continue;
4439 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (field), 1))
4440 bitsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (field), 1);
4441 else
4442 bitsize = -1;
4444 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
4445 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
4446 mode = VOIDmode;
4448 offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
4449 if (host_integerp (offset, 0)
4450 && host_integerp (bit_position (field), 0))
4452 bitpos = int_bit_position (field);
4453 offset = 0;
4455 else
4456 bitpos = tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field), 0);
4458 if (offset)
4460 rtx offset_rtx;
4462 offset
4463 = SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (offset,
4464 make_tree (TREE_TYPE (exp),
4465 target));
4467 offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
4468 gcc_assert (MEM_P (to_rtx));
4470 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4471 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != Pmode)
4472 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, offset_rtx, 0);
4473 #else
4474 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
4475 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
4476 #endif
4478 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
4479 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
4482 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
4483 /* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a
4484 word, at the start of a word, try to widen it to a full
4485 word. This special case allows us to output C++ member
4486 function initializations in a form that the optimizers
4487 can understand. */
4488 if (REG_P (target)
4489 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
4490 && bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
4491 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
4492 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
4493 && exp_size >= 0
4494 && bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= exp_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
4496 tree type = TREE_TYPE (value);
4498 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
4500 type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_size
4501 (BITS_PER_WORD, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
4502 value = convert (type, value);
4505 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
4506 value
4507 = fold (build2 (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
4508 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
4509 BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize)));
4510 bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
4511 mode = word_mode;
4513 #endif
4515 if (MEM_P (to_rtx) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx)
4516 && DECL_NONADDRESSABLE_P (field))
4518 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4519 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4522 store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode,
4523 value, type, cleared,
4524 get_alias_set (TREE_TYPE (field)));
4526 break;
4528 case ARRAY_TYPE:
4530 tree elt;
4531 int i;
4532 int need_to_clear;
4533 tree domain;
4534 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
4535 int const_bounds_p;
4536 HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = 0;
4537 HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = 0;
4539 domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
4540 const_bounds_p = (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)
4541 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
4542 && host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0)
4543 && host_integerp (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0));
4545 /* If we have constant bounds for the range of the type, get them. */
4546 if (const_bounds_p)
4548 minelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0);
4549 maxelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0);
4552 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array, clear
4553 the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
4554 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
4555 if (cleared)
4556 need_to_clear = 0;
4557 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
4558 need_to_clear = 1;
4559 else
4561 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
4562 need_to_clear = ! const_bounds_p;
4564 /* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
4565 mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index). It
4566 is also needed to check for missing elements. */
4567 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp);
4568 elt != NULL_TREE && ! need_to_clear;
4569 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
4571 tree index = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
4572 HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
4574 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
4576 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
4577 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
4579 if (! host_integerp (lo_index, 1)
4580 || ! host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
4582 need_to_clear = 1;
4583 break;
4586 this_node_count = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
4587 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
4589 else
4590 this_node_count = 1;
4592 count += this_node_count;
4593 if (mostly_zeros_p (TREE_VALUE (elt)))
4594 zero_count += this_node_count;
4597 /* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing
4598 elements, or if the incidence of zero elements is >=
4599 75%. */
4600 if (! need_to_clear
4601 && (count < maxelt - minelt + 1
4602 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count))
4603 need_to_clear = 1;
4606 if (need_to_clear && size > 0)
4608 if (REG_P (target))
4609 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
4610 else
4611 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size));
4612 cleared = 1;
4615 if (!cleared && REG_P (target))
4616 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
4617 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, target));
4619 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
4620 corresponding element of TARGET, determined by counting the
4621 elements. */
4622 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i = 0;
4623 elt;
4624 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt), i++)
4626 enum machine_mode mode;
4627 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
4628 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
4629 int unsignedp;
4630 tree value = TREE_VALUE (elt);
4631 tree index = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
4632 rtx xtarget = target;
4634 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
4635 continue;
4637 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (elttype);
4638 mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
4639 if (mode == BLKmode)
4640 bitsize = (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
4641 ? tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
4642 : -1);
4643 else
4644 bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
4646 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
4648 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
4649 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
4650 rtx index_r, pos_rtx;
4651 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
4652 tree position;
4654 /* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
4655 if (const_bounds_p
4656 && host_integerp (lo_index, 0)
4657 && host_integerp (hi_index, 0)
4658 && (lo = tree_low_cst (lo_index, 0),
4659 hi = tree_low_cst (hi_index, 0),
4660 count = hi - lo + 1,
4661 (!MEM_P (target)
4662 || count <= 2
4663 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
4664 && (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1) * count
4665 <= 40 * 8)))))
4667 lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
4668 for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
4670 bitpos = lo * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 0);
4672 if (MEM_P (target)
4673 && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
4674 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
4675 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
4677 target = copy_rtx (target);
4678 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
4681 store_constructor_field
4682 (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value, type, cleared,
4683 get_alias_set (elttype));
4686 else
4688 rtx loop_start = gen_label_rtx ();
4689 rtx loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
4690 tree exit_cond;
4692 expand_expr (hi_index, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
4693 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (domain);
4695 index = build_decl (VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
4697 index_r
4698 = gen_reg_rtx (promote_mode (domain, DECL_MODE (index),
4699 &unsignedp, 0));
4700 SET_DECL_RTL (index, index_r);
4701 store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0);
4703 /* Build the head of the loop. */
4704 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
4705 emit_label (loop_start);
4707 /* Assign value to element index. */
4708 position
4709 = convert (ssizetype,
4710 fold (build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
4711 index, TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))));
4712 position = size_binop (MULT_EXPR, position,
4713 convert (ssizetype,
4714 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
4716 pos_rtx = expand_expr (position, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
4717 xtarget = offset_address (target, pos_rtx,
4718 highest_pow2_factor (position));
4719 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
4720 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
4721 store_constructor (value, xtarget, cleared,
4722 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4723 else
4724 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0);
4726 /* Generate a conditional jump to exit the loop. */
4727 exit_cond = build2 (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
4728 index, hi_index);
4729 jumpif (exit_cond, loop_end);
4731 /* Update the loop counter, and jump to the head of
4732 the loop. */
4733 expand_assignment (index,
4734 build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
4735 index, integer_one_node), 0);
4737 emit_jump (loop_start);
4739 /* Build the end of the loop. */
4740 emit_label (loop_end);
4743 else if ((index != 0 && ! host_integerp (index, 0))
4744 || ! host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1))
4746 tree position;
4748 if (index == 0)
4749 index = ssize_int (1);
4751 if (minelt)
4752 index = fold_convert (ssizetype,
4753 fold (build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
4754 TREE_TYPE (index),
4755 index,
4756 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))));
4758 position = size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index,
4759 convert (ssizetype,
4760 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
4761 xtarget = offset_address (target,
4762 expand_expr (position, 0, VOIDmode, 0),
4763 highest_pow2_factor (position));
4764 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
4765 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0);
4767 else
4769 if (index != 0)
4770 bitpos = ((tree_low_cst (index, 0) - minelt)
4771 * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
4772 else
4773 bitpos = (i * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
4775 if (MEM_P (target) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
4776 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
4777 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
4779 target = copy_rtx (target);
4780 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
4782 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value,
4783 type, cleared, get_alias_set (elttype));
4786 break;
4789 case VECTOR_TYPE:
4791 tree elt;
4792 int i;
4793 int need_to_clear;
4794 int icode = 0;
4795 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
4796 int elt_size = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1);
4797 enum machine_mode eltmode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
4798 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
4799 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
4800 rtx *vector = NULL;
4801 unsigned n_elts;
4803 gcc_assert (eltmode != BLKmode);
4805 n_elts = TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
4806 if (REG_P (target) && VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (target)))
4808 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
4810 icode = (int) vec_init_optab->handlers[mode].insn_code;
4811 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4813 unsigned int i;
4815 vector = alloca (n_elts);
4816 for (i = 0; i < n_elts; i++)
4817 vector [i] = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
4821 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the vector,
4822 clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
4823 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
4824 if (cleared)
4825 need_to_clear = 0;
4826 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
4827 need_to_clear = 1;
4828 else
4830 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
4832 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp);
4833 elt != NULL_TREE;
4834 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
4836 int n_elts_here = tree_low_cst
4837 (int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
4838 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (elt))),
4839 TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 0), 1);
4841 count += n_elts_here;
4842 if (mostly_zeros_p (TREE_VALUE (elt)))
4843 zero_count += n_elts_here;
4846 /* Clear the entire vector first if there are any missing elements,
4847 or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
4848 need_to_clear = (count < n_elts || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count);
4851 if (need_to_clear && size > 0 && !vector)
4853 if (REG_P (target))
4854 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
4855 else
4856 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size));
4857 cleared = 1;
4860 if (!cleared && REG_P (target))
4861 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
4862 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, target));
4864 /* Store each element of the constructor into the corresponding
4865 element of TARGET, determined by counting the elements. */
4866 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i = 0;
4867 elt;
4868 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt), i += bitsize / elt_size)
4870 tree value = TREE_VALUE (elt);
4871 tree index = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
4872 HOST_WIDE_INT eltpos;
4874 bitsize = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)), 1);
4875 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
4876 continue;
4878 if (index != 0)
4879 eltpos = tree_low_cst (index, 1);
4880 else
4881 eltpos = i;
4883 if (vector)
4885 /* Vector CONSTRUCTORs should only be built from smaller
4886 vectors in the case of BLKmode vectors. */
4887 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) != VECTOR_TYPE);
4888 vector[eltpos] = expand_expr (value, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
4890 else
4892 enum machine_mode value_mode =
4893 TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE
4894 ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (value))
4895 : eltmode;
4896 bitpos = eltpos * elt_size;
4897 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
4898 value_mode, value, type,
4899 cleared, get_alias_set (elttype));
4903 if (vector)
4904 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode)
4905 (target,
4906 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (target),
4907 gen_rtvec_v (n_elts, vector))));
4908 break;
4911 /* Set constructor assignments. */
4912 case SET_TYPE:
4914 tree elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp);
4915 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT nbytes = int_size_in_bytes (type), nbits;
4916 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
4917 tree domain_min, domain_max, bitlength;
4919 /* The default implementation strategy is to extract the
4920 constant parts of the constructor, use that to initialize
4921 the target, and then "or" in whatever non-constant ranges
4922 we need in addition.
4924 If a large set is all zero or all ones, it is probably
4925 better to set it using memset. Also, if a large set has
4926 just a single range, it may also be better to first clear
4927 all the first clear the set (using memset), and set the
4928 bits we want. */
4930 /* Check for all zeros. */
4931 if (elt == NULL_TREE && size > 0)
4933 if (!cleared)
4934 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size));
4935 return;
4938 domain_min = convert (sizetype, TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain));
4939 domain_max = convert (sizetype, TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain));
4940 bitlength = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR,
4941 size_diffop (domain_max, domain_min),
4942 ssize_int (1));
4944 nbits = tree_low_cst (bitlength, 1);
4946 /* For "small" sets, or "medium-sized" (up to 32 bytes) sets
4947 that are "complicated" (more than one range), initialize
4948 (the constant parts) by copying from a constant. */
4949 if (GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode || nbits <= 2 * BITS_PER_WORD
4950 || (nbytes <= 32 && TREE_CHAIN (elt) != NULL_TREE))
4952 unsigned int set_word_size = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp));
4953 enum machine_mode mode = mode_for_size (set_word_size, MODE_INT, 1);
4954 char *bit_buffer = alloca (nbits);
4955 HOST_WIDE_INT word = 0;
4956 unsigned int bit_pos = 0;
4957 unsigned int ibit = 0;
4958 unsigned int offset = 0; /* In bytes from beginning of set. */
4960 elt = get_set_constructor_bits (exp, bit_buffer, nbits);
4961 for (;;)
4963 if (bit_buffer[ibit])
4965 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
4966 word |= (1 << (set_word_size - 1 - bit_pos));
4967 else
4968 word |= 1 << bit_pos;
4971 bit_pos++; ibit++;
4972 if (bit_pos >= set_word_size || ibit == nbits)
4974 if (word != 0 || ! cleared)
4976 rtx datum = gen_int_mode (word, mode);
4977 rtx to_rtx;
4979 /* The assumption here is that it is safe to
4980 use XEXP if the set is multi-word, but not
4981 if it's single-word. */
4982 if (MEM_P (target))
4983 to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode, offset);
4984 else
4986 gcc_assert (!offset);
4987 to_rtx = target;
4989 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, datum);
4992 if (ibit == nbits)
4993 break;
4994 word = 0;
4995 bit_pos = 0;
4996 offset += set_word_size / BITS_PER_UNIT;
5000 else if (!cleared)
5001 /* Don't bother clearing storage if the set is all ones. */
5002 if (TREE_CHAIN (elt) != NULL_TREE
5003 || (TREE_PURPOSE (elt) == NULL_TREE
5004 ? nbits != 1
5005 : ( ! host_integerp (TREE_VALUE (elt), 0)
5006 || ! host_integerp (TREE_PURPOSE (elt), 0)
5007 || (tree_low_cst (TREE_VALUE (elt), 0)
5008 - tree_low_cst (TREE_PURPOSE (elt), 0) + 1
5009 != (HOST_WIDE_INT) nbits))))
5010 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp));
5012 for (; elt != NULL_TREE; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
5014 /* Start of range of element or NULL. */
5015 tree startbit = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
5016 /* End of range of element, or element value. */
5017 tree endbit = TREE_VALUE (elt);
5018 HOST_WIDE_INT startb, endb;
5019 rtx bitlength_rtx, startbit_rtx, endbit_rtx, targetx;
5021 bitlength_rtx = expand_expr (bitlength,
5022 NULL_RTX, MEM, EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
5024 /* Handle non-range tuple element like [ expr ]. */
5025 if (startbit == NULL_TREE)
5027 startbit = save_expr (endbit);
5028 endbit = startbit;
5031 startbit = convert (sizetype, startbit);
5032 endbit = convert (sizetype, endbit);
5033 if (! integer_zerop (domain_min))
5035 startbit = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, startbit, domain_min);
5036 endbit = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, endbit, domain_min);
5038 startbit_rtx = expand_expr (startbit, NULL_RTX, MEM,
5039 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
5040 endbit_rtx = expand_expr (endbit, NULL_RTX, MEM,
5041 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
5043 if (REG_P (target))
5045 targetx
5046 = assign_temp
5047 ((build_qualified_type (lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5048 (GET_MODE (target), 0),
5049 TYPE_QUAL_CONST)),
5050 0, 1, 1);
5051 emit_move_insn (targetx, target);
5054 else
5056 gcc_assert (MEM_P (target));
5057 targetx = target;
5060 /* Optimization: If startbit and endbit are constants divisible
5061 by BITS_PER_UNIT, call memset instead. */
5062 if (TREE_CODE (startbit) == INTEGER_CST
5063 && TREE_CODE (endbit) == INTEGER_CST
5064 && (startb = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (startbit)) % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
5065 && (endb = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (endbit) + 1) % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
5067 emit_library_call (memset_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
5068 VOIDmode, 3,
5069 plus_constant (XEXP (targetx, 0),
5070 startb / BITS_PER_UNIT),
5071 Pmode,
5072 constm1_rtx, TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node),
5073 GEN_INT ((endb - startb) / BITS_PER_UNIT),
5074 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
5076 else
5077 emit_library_call (setbits_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
5078 VOIDmode, 4, XEXP (targetx, 0),
5079 Pmode, bitlength_rtx, TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
5080 startbit_rtx, TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
5081 endbit_rtx, TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
5083 if (REG_P (target))
5084 emit_move_insn (target, targetx);
5086 break;
5088 default:
5089 gcc_unreachable ();
5093 /* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
5094 into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
5095 BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
5096 If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
5098 If VALUE_MODE is VOIDmode, return nothing in particular.
5099 UNSIGNEDP is not used in this case.
5101 Otherwise, return an rtx for the value stored. This rtx
5102 has mode VALUE_MODE if that is convenient to do.
5103 In this case, UNSIGNEDP must be nonzero if the value is an unsigned type.
5105 TYPE is the type of the underlying object,
5107 ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
5108 (in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
5109 reference to the containing structure. */
5111 static rtx
5112 store_field (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
5113 enum machine_mode mode, tree exp, enum machine_mode value_mode,
5114 int unsignedp, tree type, int alias_set)
5116 HOST_WIDE_INT width_mask = 0;
5118 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
5119 return const0_rtx;
5121 /* If we have nothing to store, do nothing unless the expression has
5122 side-effects. */
5123 if (bitsize == 0)
5124 return expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
5125 else if (bitsize >= 0 && bitsize < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
5126 width_mask = ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1;
5128 /* If we are storing into an unaligned field of an aligned union that is
5129 in a register, we may have the mode of TARGET being an integer mode but
5130 MODE == BLKmode. In that case, get an aligned object whose size and
5131 alignment are the same as TARGET and store TARGET into it (we can avoid
5132 the store if the field being stored is the entire width of TARGET). Then
5133 call ourselves recursively to store the field into a BLKmode version of
5134 that object. Finally, load from the object into TARGET. This is not
5135 very efficient in general, but should only be slightly more expensive
5136 than the otherwise-required unaligned accesses. Perhaps this can be
5137 cleaned up later. It's tempting to make OBJECT readonly, but it's set
5138 twice, once with emit_move_insn and once via store_field. */
5140 if (mode == BLKmode
5141 && (REG_P (target) || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG))
5143 rtx object = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
5144 rtx blk_object = adjust_address (object, BLKmode, 0);
5146 if (bitsize != (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (target)))
5147 emit_move_insn (object, target);
5149 store_field (blk_object, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, VOIDmode, 0, type,
5150 alias_set);
5152 emit_move_insn (target, object);
5154 /* We want to return the BLKmode version of the data. */
5155 return blk_object;
5158 if (GET_CODE (target) == CONCAT)
5160 /* We're storing into a struct containing a single __complex. */
5162 gcc_assert (!bitpos);
5163 return store_expr (exp, target, value_mode != VOIDmode);
5166 /* If the structure is in a register or if the component
5167 is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
5168 Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
5170 if (mode == VOIDmode
5171 || (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
5172 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
5173 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
5174 || REG_P (target)
5175 || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
5176 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
5177 store it as a bit field. */
5178 || (mode != BLKmode
5179 && ((((MEM_ALIGN (target) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
5180 || bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
5181 && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target)))
5182 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
5183 /* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
5184 RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
5185 operations. */
5186 || (bitsize >= 0
5187 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
5188 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) != 0))
5190 rtx temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
5192 /* If BITSIZE is narrower than the size of the type of EXP
5193 we will be narrowing TEMP. Normally, what's wanted are the
5194 low-order bits. However, if EXP's type is a record and this is
5195 big-endian machine, we want the upper BITSIZE bits. */
5196 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (temp)) == MODE_INT
5197 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
5198 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == RECORD_TYPE)
5199 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (temp), temp,
5200 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
5201 - bitsize),
5202 NULL_RTX, 1);
5204 /* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to
5205 MODE. */
5206 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
5207 && mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5208 temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
5210 /* If the modes of TARGET and TEMP are both BLKmode, both
5211 must be in memory and BITPOS must be aligned on a byte
5212 boundary. If so, we simply do a block copy. */
5213 if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode && GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
5215 gcc_assert (MEM_P (target) && MEM_P (temp)
5216 && !(bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT));
5218 target = adjust_address (target, VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5219 emit_block_move (target, temp,
5220 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
5221 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
5222 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5224 return value_mode == VOIDmode ? const0_rtx : target;
5227 /* Store the value in the bitfield. */
5228 store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, temp);
5230 if (value_mode != VOIDmode)
5232 /* The caller wants an rtx for the value.
5233 If possible, avoid refetching from the bitfield itself. */
5234 if (width_mask != 0
5235 && ! (MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target)))
5237 tree count;
5238 enum machine_mode tmode;
5240 tmode = GET_MODE (temp);
5241 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
5242 tmode = value_mode;
5244 if (unsignedp)
5245 return expand_and (tmode, temp,
5246 gen_int_mode (width_mask, tmode),
5247 NULL_RTX);
5249 count = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
5250 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) - bitsize);
5251 temp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, tmode, temp, count, 0, 0);
5252 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, tmode, temp, count, 0, 0);
5255 return extract_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp,
5256 NULL_RTX, value_mode, VOIDmode);
5258 return const0_rtx;
5260 else
5262 rtx addr = XEXP (target, 0);
5263 rtx to_rtx = target;
5265 /* If a value is wanted, it must be the lhs;
5266 so make the address stable for multiple use. */
5268 if (value_mode != VOIDmode && !REG_P (addr)
5269 && ! CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (addr)
5270 /* A frame-pointer reference is already stable. */
5271 && ! (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS
5272 && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 1)) == CONST_INT
5273 && (XEXP (addr, 0) == virtual_incoming_args_rtx
5274 || XEXP (addr, 0) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx)))
5275 to_rtx = replace_equiv_address (to_rtx, copy_to_reg (addr));
5277 /* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
5279 to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5281 if (to_rtx == target)
5282 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
5284 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (to_rtx, 1);
5285 if (!MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) && MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) != 0)
5286 set_mem_alias_set (to_rtx, alias_set);
5288 return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, value_mode != VOIDmode);
5292 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
5293 an ARRAY_REF, or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for nested operations of these
5294 codes and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
5296 We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
5297 bit position, and *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness of the field.
5298 If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
5299 giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
5300 This offset is in addition to the bit position.
5301 If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
5303 If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
5304 we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
5306 If the field is a bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode. Otherwise, it
5307 is a mode that can be used to access the field. In that case, *PBITSIZE
5308 is redundant.
5310 If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
5311 VOIDmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
5312 this case, but the address of the object can be found. */
5314 tree
5315 get_inner_reference (tree exp, HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitsize,
5316 HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitpos, tree *poffset,
5317 enum machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp,
5318 int *pvolatilep)
5320 tree size_tree = 0;
5321 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
5322 tree offset = size_zero_node;
5323 tree bit_offset = bitsize_zero_node;
5324 tree tem;
5326 /* First get the mode, signedness, and size. We do this from just the
5327 outermost expression. */
5328 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
5330 size_tree = DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
5331 if (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
5332 mode = DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
5334 *punsignedp = DECL_UNSIGNED (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
5336 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
5338 size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
5339 *punsignedp = BIT_FIELD_REF_UNSIGNED (exp);
5341 else
5343 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
5344 *punsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
5346 if (mode == BLKmode)
5347 size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
5348 else
5349 *pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
5352 if (size_tree != 0)
5354 if (! host_integerp (size_tree, 1))
5355 mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
5356 else
5357 *pbitsize = tree_low_cst (size_tree, 1);
5360 /* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
5361 and find the ultimate containing object. */
5362 while (1)
5364 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
5365 bit_offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, bit_offset, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
5366 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
5368 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
5369 tree this_offset = component_ref_field_offset (exp);
5371 /* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go
5372 past it. This should only happen when folding expressions
5373 made during type construction. */
5374 if (this_offset == 0)
5375 break;
5377 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, this_offset);
5378 bit_offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, bit_offset,
5379 DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field));
5381 /* ??? Right now we don't do anything with DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN. */
5384 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ARRAY_REF
5385 || TREE_CODE (exp) == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
5387 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
5388 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
5389 tree unit_size = array_ref_element_size (exp);
5391 /* We assume all arrays have sizes that are a multiple of a byte.
5392 First subtract the lower bound, if any, in the type of the
5393 index, then convert to sizetype and multiply by the size of the
5394 array element. */
5395 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
5396 index = fold (build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
5397 index, low_bound));
5399 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
5400 size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
5401 convert (sizetype, index),
5402 unit_size));
5405 /* We can go inside most conversions: all NON_VALUE_EXPRs, all normal
5406 conversions that don't change the mode, and all view conversions
5407 except those that need to "step up" the alignment. */
5408 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) != NON_LVALUE_EXPR
5409 && ! (TREE_CODE (exp) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
5410 && ! ((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5411 > TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
5412 && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
5413 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
5414 < BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
5415 && (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5416 || TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE
5417 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))))
5418 && ! ((TREE_CODE (exp) == NOP_EXPR
5419 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CONVERT_EXPR)
5420 && (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5421 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))))
5422 break;
5424 /* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
5425 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
5426 *pvolatilep = 1;
5428 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
5431 /* If OFFSET is constant, see if we can return the whole thing as a
5432 constant bit position. Otherwise, split it up. */
5433 if (host_integerp (offset, 0)
5434 && 0 != (tem = size_binop (MULT_EXPR, convert (bitsizetype, offset),
5435 bitsize_unit_node))
5436 && 0 != (tem = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, tem, bit_offset))
5437 && host_integerp (tem, 0))
5438 *pbitpos = tree_low_cst (tem, 0), *poffset = 0;
5439 else
5440 *pbitpos = tree_low_cst (bit_offset, 0), *poffset = offset;
5442 *pmode = mode;
5443 return exp;
5446 /* Return a tree of sizetype representing the size, in bytes, of the element
5447 of EXP, an ARRAY_REF. */
5449 tree
5450 array_ref_element_size (tree exp)
5452 tree aligned_size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 3);
5453 tree elmt_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
5455 /* If a size was specified in the ARRAY_REF, it's the size measured
5456 in alignment units of the element type. So multiply by that value. */
5457 if (aligned_size)
5459 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
5460 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
5461 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_size) != sizetype)
5462 aligned_size = fold_convert (sizetype, aligned_size);
5463 return size_binop (MULT_EXPR, aligned_size,
5464 size_int (TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (elmt_type)));
5467 /* Otherwise, take the size from that of the element type. Substitute
5468 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
5469 else
5470 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elmt_type), exp);
5473 /* Return a tree representing the lower bound of the array mentioned in
5474 EXP, an ARRAY_REF. */
5476 tree
5477 array_ref_low_bound (tree exp)
5479 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
5481 /* If a lower bound is specified in EXP, use it. */
5482 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))
5483 return TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
5485 /* Otherwise, if there is a domain type and it has a lower bound, use it,
5486 substituting for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
5487 if (domain_type && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type))
5488 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
5490 /* Otherwise, return a zero of the appropriate type. */
5491 return build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)), 0);
5494 /* Return a tree representing the upper bound of the array mentioned in
5495 EXP, an ARRAY_REF. */
5497 tree
5498 array_ref_up_bound (tree exp)
5500 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
5502 /* If there is a domain type and it has an upper bound, use it, substituting
5503 for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
5504 if (domain_type && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type))
5505 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
5507 /* Otherwise fail. */
5508 return NULL_TREE;
5511 /* Return a tree representing the offset, in bytes, of the field referenced
5512 by EXP. This does not include any offset in DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET. */
5514 tree
5515 component_ref_field_offset (tree exp)
5517 tree aligned_offset = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
5518 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
5520 /* If an offset was specified in the COMPONENT_REF, it's the offset measured
5521 in units of DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN / BITS_PER_UNIT. So multiply by that
5522 value. */
5523 if (aligned_offset)
5525 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
5526 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
5527 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_offset) != sizetype)
5528 aligned_offset = fold_convert (sizetype, aligned_offset);
5529 return size_binop (MULT_EXPR, aligned_offset,
5530 size_int (DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN (field) / BITS_PER_UNIT));
5533 /* Otherwise, take the offset from that of the field. Substitute
5534 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
5535 else
5536 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), exp);
5539 /* Return 1 if T is an expression that get_inner_reference handles. */
5542 handled_component_p (tree t)
5544 switch (TREE_CODE (t))
5546 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
5547 case COMPONENT_REF:
5548 case ARRAY_REF:
5549 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
5550 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
5551 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
5552 return 1;
5554 /* ??? Sure they are handled, but get_inner_reference may return
5555 a different PBITSIZE, depending upon whether the expression is
5556 wrapped up in a NOP_EXPR or not, e.g. for bitfields. */
5557 case NOP_EXPR:
5558 case CONVERT_EXPR:
5559 return (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (t))
5560 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (t, 0))));
5562 default:
5563 return 0;
5567 /* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications, return
5568 an equivalent value that just refers to a register, memory, or constant.
5569 This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic and
5570 returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
5572 The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
5575 force_operand (rtx value, rtx target)
5577 rtx op1, op2;
5578 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
5579 rtx subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
5580 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (value);
5582 /* Check for subreg applied to an expression produced by loop optimizer. */
5583 if (code == SUBREG
5584 && !REG_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
5585 && !MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
5587 value = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
5588 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
5589 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
5590 NULL_RTX)),
5591 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
5592 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
5593 code = GET_CODE (value);
5596 /* Check for a PIC address load. */
5597 if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
5598 && XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
5599 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
5600 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
5601 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
5603 if (!subtarget)
5604 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
5605 emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
5606 return subtarget;
5609 if (code == ZERO_EXTEND || code == SIGN_EXTEND)
5611 if (!target)
5612 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
5613 convert_move (target, force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL),
5614 code == ZERO_EXTEND);
5615 return target;
5618 if (ARITHMETIC_P (value))
5620 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
5621 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2) && !(REG_P (op2) && op2 != subtarget))
5622 subtarget = 0;
5623 if (code == MINUS && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_INT)
5625 code = PLUS;
5626 op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
5629 /* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
5630 operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
5631 case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
5632 constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
5633 register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
5634 creating another one around this addition. */
5635 if (code == PLUS && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_INT
5636 && GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
5637 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0))
5638 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
5639 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
5641 rtx temp = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code,
5642 XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
5643 subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5644 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, temp,
5645 force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value,
5646 0), 1), 0),
5647 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5650 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
5651 op2 = force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX);
5652 switch (code)
5654 case MULT:
5655 return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 1);
5656 case DIV:
5657 if (!INTEGRAL_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value)))
5658 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
5659 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5660 else
5661 return expand_divmod (0,
5662 FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value))
5663 ? RDIV_EXPR : TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
5664 GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 0);
5665 break;
5666 case MOD:
5667 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
5668 target, 0);
5669 break;
5670 case UDIV:
5671 return expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
5672 target, 1);
5673 break;
5674 case UMOD:
5675 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
5676 target, 1);
5677 break;
5678 case ASHIFTRT:
5679 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
5680 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5681 break;
5682 default:
5683 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
5684 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5687 if (UNARY_P (value))
5689 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL_RTX);
5690 return expand_simple_unop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, target, 0);
5693 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
5694 /* On machines that have insn scheduling, we want all memory reference to be
5695 explicit, so we need to deal with such paradoxical SUBREGs. */
5696 if (GET_CODE (value) == SUBREG && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
5697 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (value))
5698 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)))))
5699 value
5700 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
5701 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
5702 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
5703 NULL_RTX)),
5704 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
5705 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
5706 #endif
5708 return value;
5711 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff there is no way that
5712 EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
5713 call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
5714 for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
5716 It is always safe for this routine to return zero since it merely
5717 searches for optimization opportunities. */
5720 safe_from_p (rtx x, tree exp, int top_p)
5722 rtx exp_rtl = 0;
5723 int i, nops;
5725 if (x == 0
5726 /* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
5727 have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
5728 (except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
5729 So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
5730 clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
5731 do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
5732 || (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5733 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
5734 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
5735 || TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
5736 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5737 != INTEGER_CST)
5738 && GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode)
5739 /* If X is in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
5740 || (MEM_P (x)
5741 && (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
5742 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
5743 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx))))
5744 return 1;
5746 /* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
5747 find the underlying pseudo. */
5748 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
5750 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
5751 if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5752 return 0;
5755 /* Now look at our tree code and possibly recurse. */
5756 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
5758 case 'd':
5759 exp_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp);
5760 break;
5762 case 'c':
5763 return 1;
5765 case 'x':
5766 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
5768 while (1)
5770 if (TREE_VALUE (exp) && !safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
5771 return 0;
5772 exp = TREE_CHAIN (exp);
5773 if (!exp)
5774 return 1;
5775 if (TREE_CODE (exp) != TREE_LIST)
5776 return safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
5779 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
5780 return 1; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
5781 else
5782 return 0;
5784 case 's':
5785 /* The only case we look at here is the DECL_INITIAL inside a
5786 DECL_EXPR. */
5787 return (TREE_CODE (exp) != DECL_EXPR
5788 || TREE_CODE (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)) != VAR_DECL
5789 || !DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp))
5790 || safe_from_p (x, DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)), 0));
5792 case '2':
5793 case '<':
5794 if (!safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
5795 return 0;
5796 /* Fall through. */
5798 case '1':
5799 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
5801 case 'e':
5802 case 'r':
5803 /* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
5804 the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
5805 both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
5806 expression recursively. */
5808 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
5810 case ADDR_EXPR:
5811 /* If the operand is static or we are static, we can't conflict.
5812 Likewise if we don't conflict with the operand at all. */
5813 if (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
5814 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
5815 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
5816 return 1;
5818 /* Otherwise, the only way this can conflict is if we are taking
5819 the address of a DECL a that address if part of X, which is
5820 very rare. */
5821 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
5822 if (DECL_P (exp))
5824 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp)
5825 || !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp)))
5826 return 0;
5827 else
5828 exp_rtl = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
5830 break;
5832 case INDIRECT_REF:
5833 if (MEM_P (x)
5834 && alias_sets_conflict_p (MEM_ALIAS_SET (x),
5835 get_alias_set (exp)))
5836 return 0;
5837 break;
5839 case CALL_EXPR:
5840 /* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
5841 all of memory. */
5842 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5843 || MEM_P (x))
5844 return 0;
5845 break;
5847 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
5848 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
5849 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
5850 gcc_unreachable ();
5852 case SAVE_EXPR:
5853 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
5855 default:
5856 break;
5859 /* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
5860 if (exp_rtl)
5861 break;
5863 nops = first_rtl_op (TREE_CODE (exp));
5864 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
5865 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
5866 && ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
5867 return 0;
5869 /* If this is a language-specific tree code, it may require
5870 special handling. */
5871 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (exp)
5872 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE
5873 && !lang_hooks.safe_from_p (x, exp))
5874 return 0;
5877 /* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
5878 with it. */
5879 if (exp_rtl)
5881 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
5883 exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
5884 if (REG_P (exp_rtl)
5885 && REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5886 return 0;
5889 /* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
5890 are memory and they conflict. */
5891 return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
5892 || (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (exp_rtl)
5893 && true_dependence (exp_rtl, VOIDmode, x,
5894 rtx_addr_varies_p)));
5897 /* If we reach here, it is safe. */
5898 return 1;
5902 /* Return the highest power of two that EXP is known to be a multiple of.
5903 This is used in updating alignment of MEMs in array references. */
5905 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
5906 highest_pow2_factor (tree exp)
5908 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c0, c1;
5910 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
5912 case INTEGER_CST:
5913 /* We can find the lowest bit that's a one. If the low
5914 HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT bits are zero, return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT.
5915 We need to handle this case since we can find it in a COND_EXPR,
5916 a MIN_EXPR, or a MAX_EXPR. If the constant overflows, we have an
5917 erroneous program, so return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT to avoid any
5918 later ICE. */
5919 if (TREE_CONSTANT_OVERFLOW (exp))
5920 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
5921 else
5923 /* Note: tree_low_cst is intentionally not used here,
5924 we don't care about the upper bits. */
5925 c0 = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp);
5926 c0 &= -c0;
5927 return c0 ? c0 : BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
5929 break;
5931 case PLUS_EXPR: case MINUS_EXPR: case MIN_EXPR: case MAX_EXPR:
5932 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
5933 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
5934 return MIN (c0, c1);
5936 case MULT_EXPR:
5937 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
5938 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
5939 return c0 * c1;
5941 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR: case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR: case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
5942 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
5943 if (integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
5944 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
5946 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
5947 c1 = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1);
5948 return MAX (1, c0 / c1);
5950 break;
5952 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR: case NOP_EXPR: case CONVERT_EXPR:
5953 case SAVE_EXPR:
5954 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
5956 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
5957 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
5959 case COND_EXPR:
5960 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
5961 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
5962 return MIN (c0, c1);
5964 default:
5965 break;
5968 return 1;
5971 /* Similar, except that the alignment requirements of TARGET are
5972 taken into account. Assume it is at least as aligned as its
5973 type, unless it is a COMPONENT_REF in which case the layout of
5974 the structure gives the alignment. */
5976 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
5977 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (tree target, tree exp)
5979 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT target_align, factor;
5981 factor = highest_pow2_factor (exp);
5982 if (TREE_CODE (target) == COMPONENT_REF)
5983 target_align = DECL_ALIGN_UNIT (TREE_OPERAND (target, 1));
5984 else
5985 target_align = TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (target));
5986 return MAX (factor, target_align);
5989 /* Expands variable VAR. */
5991 void
5992 expand_var (tree var)
5994 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (var))
5995 return;
5997 if (TREE_STATIC (var))
5998 /* If this is an inlined copy of a static local variable,
5999 look up the original decl. */
6000 var = DECL_ORIGIN (var);
6002 if (TREE_STATIC (var)
6003 ? !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (var)
6004 : !DECL_RTL_SET_P (var))
6006 if (TREE_CODE (var) == VAR_DECL && DECL_VALUE_EXPR (var))
6007 /* Should be ignored. */;
6008 else if (lang_hooks.expand_decl (var))
6009 /* OK. */;
6010 else if (TREE_CODE (var) == VAR_DECL && !TREE_STATIC (var))
6011 expand_decl (var);
6012 else if (TREE_CODE (var) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (var))
6013 rest_of_decl_compilation (var, 0, 0);
6014 else
6015 /* No expansion needed. */
6016 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (var) == TYPE_DECL
6017 || TREE_CODE (var) == CONST_DECL
6018 || TREE_CODE (var) == FUNCTION_DECL
6019 || TREE_CODE (var) == LABEL_DECL);
6023 /* Subroutine of expand_expr. Expand the two operands of a binary
6024 expression EXP0 and EXP1 placing the results in OP0 and OP1.
6025 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero. The
6026 MODIFIER argument is as documented by expand_expr. */
6028 static void
6029 expand_operands (tree exp0, tree exp1, rtx target, rtx *op0, rtx *op1,
6030 enum expand_modifier modifier)
6032 if (! safe_from_p (target, exp1, 1))
6033 target = 0;
6034 if (operand_equal_p (exp0, exp1, 0))
6036 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
6037 *op1 = copy_rtx (*op0);
6039 else
6041 /* If we need to preserve evaluation order, copy exp0 into its own
6042 temporary variable so that it can't be clobbered by exp1. */
6043 if (flag_evaluation_order && TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp1))
6044 exp0 = save_expr (exp0);
6045 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
6046 *op1 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
6051 /* A subroutine of expand_expr_addr_expr. Evaluate the address of EXP.
6052 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
6054 static rtx
6055 expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
6056 enum expand_modifier modifier)
6058 rtx result, subtarget;
6059 tree inner, offset;
6060 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
6061 int volatilep, unsignedp;
6062 enum machine_mode mode1;
6064 /* If we are taking the address of a constant and are at the top level,
6065 we have to use output_constant_def since we can't call force_const_mem
6066 at top level. */
6067 /* ??? This should be considered a front-end bug. We should not be
6068 generating ADDR_EXPR of something that isn't an LVALUE. The only
6069 exception here is STRING_CST. */
6070 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
6071 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)) == 'c')
6072 return XEXP (output_constant_def (exp, 0), 0);
6074 /* Everything must be something allowed by is_gimple_addressable. */
6075 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6077 case INDIRECT_REF:
6078 /* This case will happen via recursion for &a->b. */
6079 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6081 case CONST_DECL:
6082 /* Recurse and make the output_constant_def clause above handle this. */
6083 return expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target,
6084 tmode, modifier);
6086 case REALPART_EXPR:
6087 /* The real part of the complex number is always first, therefore
6088 the address is the same as the address of the parent object. */
6089 offset = 0;
6090 bitpos = 0;
6091 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6092 break;
6094 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
6095 /* The imaginary part of the complex number is always second.
6096 The expression is therefore always offset by the size of the
6097 scalar type. */
6098 offset = 0;
6099 bitpos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6100 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6101 break;
6103 default:
6104 /* If the object is a DECL, then expand it for its rtl. Don't bypass
6105 expand_expr, as that can have various side effects; LABEL_DECLs for
6106 example, may not have their DECL_RTL set yet. Assume language
6107 specific tree nodes can be expanded in some interesting way. */
6108 if (DECL_P (exp)
6109 || TREE_CODE (exp) >= LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
6111 result = expand_expr (exp, target, tmode,
6112 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6113 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
6115 /* If the DECL isn't in memory, then the DECL wasn't properly
6116 marked TREE_ADDRESSABLE, which will be either a front-end
6117 or a tree optimizer bug. */
6118 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (result) == MEM);
6119 result = XEXP (result, 0);
6121 /* ??? Is this needed anymore? */
6122 if (!TREE_USED (exp) == 0)
6124 assemble_external (exp);
6125 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
6128 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6129 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
6130 result = force_operand (result, target);
6131 return result;
6134 inner = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
6135 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep);
6136 break;
6139 /* We must have made progress. */
6140 gcc_assert (inner != exp);
6142 subtarget = offset || bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
6143 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (inner, subtarget, tmode, modifier);
6145 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
6147 tmode = GET_MODE (result);
6148 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
6149 tmode = Pmode;
6152 if (offset)
6154 rtx tmp;
6156 if (modifier != EXPAND_NORMAL)
6157 result = force_operand (result, NULL);
6158 tmp = expand_expr (offset, NULL, tmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6160 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM)
6161 result = gen_rtx_PLUS (tmode, result, tmp);
6162 else
6164 subtarget = bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
6165 result = expand_simple_binop (tmode, PLUS, result, tmp, subtarget,
6166 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6170 if (bitpos)
6172 /* Someone beforehand should have rejected taking the address
6173 of such an object. */
6174 gcc_assert (!(bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT));
6176 result = plus_constant (result, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6177 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
6178 result = force_operand (result, target);
6181 return result;
6184 /* A subroutine of expand_expr. Evaluate EXP, which is an ADDR_EXPR.
6185 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
6187 static rtx
6188 expand_expr_addr_expr (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
6189 enum expand_modifier modifier)
6191 enum machine_mode rmode;
6192 rtx result;
6194 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target,
6195 tmode, modifier);
6197 /* Despite expand_expr claims concerning ignoring TMODE when not
6198 strictly convenient, stuff breaks if we don't honor it. */
6199 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
6200 tmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6201 rmode = GET_MODE (result);
6202 if (rmode == VOIDmode)
6203 rmode = tmode;
6204 if (rmode != tmode)
6205 result = convert_memory_address (tmode, result);
6207 return result;
6211 /* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
6212 An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
6213 In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
6215 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
6216 TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
6217 the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
6219 If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
6221 If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
6222 result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
6223 Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
6224 TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
6225 the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
6227 Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
6228 probably will not be used.
6230 If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
6231 we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
6232 or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
6233 products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
6234 Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
6235 and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
6237 EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
6238 it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
6239 It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
6240 This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
6242 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
6243 with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
6244 EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect.
6246 EXPAND_STACK_PARM is used when expanding to a TARGET on the stack for
6247 a call parameter. Such targets require special care as we haven't yet
6248 marked TARGET so that it's safe from being trashed by libcalls. We
6249 don't want to use TARGET for anything but the final result;
6250 Intermediate values must go elsewhere. Additionally, calls to
6251 emit_block_move will be flagged with BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM.
6253 If EXP is a VAR_DECL whose DECL_RTL was a MEM with an invalid
6254 address, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL, then *ALT_RTL is set to the
6255 DECL_RTL of the VAR_DECL. *ALT_RTL is also set if EXP is a
6256 COMPOUND_EXPR whose second argument is such a VAR_DECL, and so on
6257 recursively. */
6259 static rtx expand_expr_real_1 (tree, rtx, enum machine_mode,
6260 enum expand_modifier, rtx *);
6263 expand_expr_real (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
6264 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
6266 int rn = -1;
6267 rtx ret, last = NULL;
6269 /* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
6270 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK
6271 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == ERROR_MARK)
6273 ret = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
6274 return ret ? ret : const0_rtx;
6277 if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
6279 rn = lookup_stmt_eh_region (exp);
6280 /* If rn < 0, then either (1) tree-ssa not used or (2) doesn't throw. */
6281 if (rn >= 0)
6282 last = get_last_insn ();
6285 /* If this is an expression of some kind and it has an associated line
6286 number, then emit the line number before expanding the expression.
6288 We need to save and restore the file and line information so that
6289 errors discovered during expansion are emitted with the right
6290 information. It would be better of the diagnostic routines
6291 used the file/line information embedded in the tree nodes rather
6292 than globals. */
6293 if (cfun && EXPR_HAS_LOCATION (exp))
6295 location_t saved_location = input_location;
6296 input_location = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
6297 emit_line_note (input_location);
6299 /* Record where the insns produced belong. */
6300 record_block_change (TREE_BLOCK (exp));
6302 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
6304 input_location = saved_location;
6306 else
6308 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
6311 /* If using non-call exceptions, mark all insns that may trap.
6312 expand_call() will mark CALL_INSNs before we get to this code,
6313 but it doesn't handle libcalls, and these may trap. */
6314 if (rn >= 0)
6316 rtx insn;
6317 for (insn = next_real_insn (last); insn;
6318 insn = next_real_insn (insn))
6320 if (! find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX)
6321 /* If we want exceptions for non-call insns, any
6322 may_trap_p instruction may throw. */
6323 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER
6324 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE
6325 && (CALL_P (insn) || may_trap_p (PATTERN (insn))))
6327 REG_NOTES (insn) = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_EH_REGION, GEN_INT (rn),
6328 REG_NOTES (insn));
6333 return ret;
6336 static rtx
6337 expand_expr_real_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
6338 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
6340 rtx op0, op1, temp;
6341 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
6342 int unsignedp;
6343 enum machine_mode mode;
6344 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
6345 optab this_optab;
6346 rtx subtarget, original_target;
6347 int ignore;
6348 tree context;
6349 bool reduce_bit_field = false;
6350 #define REDUCE_BIT_FIELD(expr) (reduce_bit_field && !ignore \
6351 ? reduce_to_bit_field_precision ((expr), \
6352 target, \
6353 type) \
6354 : (expr))
6356 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
6357 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
6358 if (lang_hooks.reduce_bit_field_operations
6359 && TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE
6360 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type))
6362 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
6363 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
6364 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
6365 reduce_bit_field = true;
6366 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
6367 target = 0;
6370 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
6371 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
6372 original_target = target;
6373 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
6374 || ((code == NON_LVALUE_EXPR || code == NOP_EXPR
6375 || code == CONVERT_EXPR || code == COND_EXPR
6376 || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
6377 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
6379 /* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
6380 if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
6381 is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
6382 not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
6383 is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
6385 if (ignore)
6387 if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
6388 return const0_rtx;
6390 /* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
6391 don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
6392 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
6393 && TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
6394 && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
6395 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
6397 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
6398 if (MEM_P (temp))
6399 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
6400 return const0_rtx;
6403 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '1' || code == COMPONENT_REF
6404 || code == INDIRECT_REF)
6405 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
6406 modifier);
6408 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '2' || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '<'
6409 || code == ARRAY_REF || code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
6411 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
6412 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
6413 return const0_rtx;
6415 else if ((code == TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR || code == TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR)
6416 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
6417 /* If the second operand has no side effects, just evaluate
6418 the first. */
6419 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
6420 modifier);
6421 else if (code == BIT_FIELD_REF)
6423 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
6424 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
6425 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
6426 return const0_rtx;
6429 target = 0;
6432 /* If will do cse, generate all results into pseudo registers
6433 since 1) that allows cse to find more things
6434 and 2) otherwise cse could produce an insn the machine
6435 cannot support. An exception is a CONSTRUCTOR into a multi-word
6436 MEM: that's much more likely to be most efficient into the MEM.
6437 Another is a CALL_EXPR which must return in memory. */
6439 if (! cse_not_expected && mode != BLKmode && target
6440 && (!REG_P (target) || REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6441 && ! (code == CONSTRUCTOR && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
6442 && ! (code == CALL_EXPR && aggregate_value_p (exp, exp)))
6443 target = 0;
6445 switch (code)
6447 case LABEL_DECL:
6449 tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
6451 temp = label_rtx (exp);
6452 temp = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, temp);
6454 if (function != current_function_decl
6455 && function != 0)
6456 LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (temp) = 1;
6458 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, temp);
6459 return temp;
6462 case SSA_NAME:
6463 return expand_expr_real_1 (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp), target, tmode, modifier,
6464 NULL);
6466 case PARM_DECL:
6467 case VAR_DECL:
6468 /* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
6469 but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
6470 if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0
6471 && COMPLETE_OR_UNBOUND_ARRAY_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6472 && (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
6473 layout_decl (exp, 0);
6475 /* ... fall through ... */
6477 case FUNCTION_DECL:
6478 case RESULT_DECL:
6479 gcc_assert (DECL_RTL (exp));
6481 /* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
6482 a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
6483 definition. */
6484 if (! TREE_USED (exp))
6486 assemble_external (exp);
6487 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
6490 /* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
6491 temp = 0;
6493 /* Variables inherited from containing functions should have
6494 been lowered by this point. */
6495 context = decl_function_context (exp);
6496 gcc_assert (!context
6497 || context == current_function_decl
6498 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
6499 /* ??? C++ creates functions that are not TREE_STATIC. */
6500 || TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL);
6502 /* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
6503 from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
6504 See expand_decl. */
6506 if (MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp))
6507 && REG_P (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0)))
6508 temp = validize_mem (DECL_RTL (exp));
6510 /* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and either
6511 the address is not valid or it is not a register and -fforce-addr
6512 is specified, get the address into a register. */
6514 else if (MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp))
6515 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6516 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
6517 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6518 && (! memory_address_p (DECL_MODE (exp),
6519 XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0))
6520 || (flag_force_addr
6521 && !REG_P (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0)))))
6523 if (alt_rtl)
6524 *alt_rtl = DECL_RTL (exp);
6525 temp = replace_equiv_address (DECL_RTL (exp),
6526 copy_rtx (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0)));
6529 /* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
6530 if the address is a register. */
6531 if (temp != 0)
6533 if (MEM_P (temp) && REG_P (XEXP (temp, 0)))
6534 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0), DECL_ALIGN (exp));
6536 return temp;
6539 /* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl, it
6540 must be a promoted value. We return a SUBREG of the wanted mode,
6541 but mark it so that we know that it was already extended. */
6543 if (REG_P (DECL_RTL (exp))
6544 && GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) != DECL_MODE (exp))
6546 enum machine_mode pmode;
6548 /* Get the signedness used for this variable. Ensure we get the
6549 same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
6550 pmode = promote_mode (type, DECL_MODE (exp), &unsignedp,
6551 (TREE_CODE (exp) == RESULT_DECL ? 1 : 0));
6552 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) == pmode);
6554 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, DECL_RTL (exp));
6555 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
6556 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
6557 return temp;
6560 return DECL_RTL (exp);
6562 case INTEGER_CST:
6563 temp = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp),
6564 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (exp), mode);
6566 /* ??? If overflow is set, fold will have done an incomplete job,
6567 which can result in (plus xx (const_int 0)), which can get
6568 simplified by validate_replace_rtx during virtual register
6569 instantiation, which can result in unrecognizable insns.
6570 Avoid this by forcing all overflows into registers. */
6571 if (TREE_CONSTANT_OVERFLOW (exp)
6572 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
6573 temp = force_reg (mode, temp);
6575 return temp;
6577 case VECTOR_CST:
6578 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == MODE_VECTOR_INT
6579 || GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT)
6580 return const_vector_from_tree (exp);
6581 else
6582 return expand_expr (build1 (CONSTRUCTOR, TREE_TYPE (exp),
6583 TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (exp)),
6584 ignore ? const0_rtx : target, tmode, modifier);
6586 case CONST_DECL:
6587 return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode, modifier);
6589 case REAL_CST:
6590 /* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
6591 which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
6593 We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
6594 this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
6595 the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
6596 On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
6597 many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
6599 Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
6600 return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (exp),
6601 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6603 case COMPLEX_CST:
6604 /* Handle evaluating a complex constant in a CONCAT target. */
6605 if (original_target && GET_CODE (original_target) == CONCAT)
6607 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6608 rtx rtarg, itarg;
6610 rtarg = XEXP (original_target, 0);
6611 itarg = XEXP (original_target, 1);
6613 /* Move the real and imaginary parts separately. */
6614 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_REALPART (exp), rtarg, mode, 0);
6615 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_IMAGPART (exp), itarg, mode, 0);
6617 if (op0 != rtarg)
6618 emit_move_insn (rtarg, op0);
6619 if (op1 != itarg)
6620 emit_move_insn (itarg, op1);
6622 return original_target;
6625 /* ... fall through ... */
6627 case STRING_CST:
6628 temp = output_constant_def (exp, 1);
6630 /* temp contains a constant address.
6631 On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
6632 make some insns to get that address into a register. */
6633 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6634 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6635 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
6636 && (! memory_address_p (mode, XEXP (temp, 0))
6637 || flag_force_addr))
6638 return replace_equiv_address (temp,
6639 copy_rtx (XEXP (temp, 0)));
6640 return temp;
6642 case SAVE_EXPR:
6644 tree val = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6645 rtx ret = expand_expr_real_1 (val, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
6647 if (!SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp))
6649 /* We can indeed still hit this case, typically via builtin
6650 expanders calling save_expr immediately before expanding
6651 something. Assume this means that we only have to deal
6652 with non-BLKmode values. */
6653 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (ret) != BLKmode);
6655 val = build_decl (VAR_DECL, NULL, TREE_TYPE (exp));
6656 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (val) = 1;
6657 DECL_IGNORED_P (val) = 1;
6658 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = val;
6659 SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp) = 1;
6661 if (!CONSTANT_P (ret))
6662 ret = copy_to_reg (ret);
6663 SET_DECL_RTL (val, ret);
6666 return ret;
6669 case GOTO_EXPR:
6670 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == LABEL_DECL)
6671 expand_goto (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6672 else
6673 expand_computed_goto (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6674 return const0_rtx;
6676 case CONSTRUCTOR:
6677 /* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
6678 subexpressions. */
6679 if (ignore)
6681 tree elt;
6683 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp); elt; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
6684 expand_expr (TREE_VALUE (elt), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
6686 return const0_rtx;
6689 /* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
6690 if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
6691 since that should make a CONST_INT or CONST_DOUBLE when we
6692 fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can use, it is best to
6693 store directly into the target unless the type is large enough
6694 that memcpy will be used. If we are making an initializer and
6695 all operands are constant, put it in memory as well.
6697 FIXME: Avoid trying to fill vector constructors piece-meal.
6698 Output them with output_constant_def below unless we're sure
6699 they're zeros. This should go away when vector initializers
6700 are treated like VECTOR_CST instead of arrays.
6702 else if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
6703 && ((mode == BLKmode
6704 && ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
6705 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
6706 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1)
6707 && (! MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
6708 (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1),
6709 TYPE_ALIGN (type)))
6710 && ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))))
6711 || ((modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6712 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
6713 && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
6715 rtx constructor = output_constant_def (exp, 1);
6717 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6718 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6719 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
6720 constructor = validize_mem (constructor);
6722 return constructor;
6724 else
6726 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
6727 locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
6728 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
6729 || GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL
6730 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
6731 target
6732 = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type,
6733 (TYPE_QUALS (type)
6734 | (TREE_READONLY (exp)
6735 * TYPE_QUAL_CONST))),
6736 0, TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp), 1);
6738 store_constructor (exp, target, 0, int_expr_size (exp));
6739 return target;
6742 case INDIRECT_REF:
6744 tree exp1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6745 tree orig;
6747 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE)
6749 tree t;
6751 t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
6752 if (t)
6753 return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
6756 op0 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
6757 op0 = memory_address (mode, op0);
6758 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
6760 orig = REF_ORIGINAL (exp);
6761 if (!orig)
6762 orig = exp;
6763 set_mem_attributes (temp, orig, 0);
6765 return temp;
6768 case ARRAY_REF:
6771 tree array = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6772 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
6773 tree index = convert (sizetype, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
6774 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
6776 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (array)) == ARRAY_TYPE);
6778 /* Optimize the special-case of a zero lower bound.
6780 We convert the low_bound to sizetype to avoid some problems
6781 with constant folding. (E.g. suppose the lower bound is 1,
6782 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion, (ARRAY
6783 +(INDEX-(unsigned char)1)) becomes ((ARRAY+(-(unsigned char)1))
6784 +INDEX), which becomes (ARRAY+255+INDEX). Oops!) */
6786 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
6787 index = size_diffop (index, convert (sizetype, low_bound));
6789 /* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
6790 This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
6791 Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
6792 difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
6794 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6795 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6796 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
6798 tree t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
6800 if (t)
6801 return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
6804 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
6805 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
6806 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
6807 that was declared const. */
6809 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6810 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6811 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
6812 && TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR
6813 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
6814 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
6815 && 0 > compare_tree_int (index,
6816 list_length (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS
6817 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
6819 tree elem;
6821 for (elem = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)),
6822 i = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index);
6823 elem != 0 && i != 0; i--, elem = TREE_CHAIN (elem))
6826 if (elem)
6827 return expand_expr (fold (TREE_VALUE (elem)), target, tmode,
6828 modifier);
6831 else if (optimize >= 1
6832 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6833 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6834 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
6835 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
6836 && TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (array)
6837 && TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != ERROR_MARK
6838 && targetm.binds_local_p (array))
6840 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
6842 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (array);
6844 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6846 tree elem;
6848 for (elem = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
6849 (elem
6850 && !tree_int_cst_equal (TREE_PURPOSE (elem), index));
6851 elem = TREE_CHAIN (elem))
6854 if (elem && !TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_VALUE (elem)))
6855 return expand_expr (fold (TREE_VALUE (elem)), target,
6856 tmode, modifier);
6858 else if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST
6859 && 0 > compare_tree_int (index,
6860 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)))
6862 tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (init));
6863 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
6865 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6866 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1)
6867 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)
6868 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index)], mode);
6873 goto normal_inner_ref;
6875 case COMPONENT_REF:
6876 /* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
6877 appropriate field if it is present. */
6878 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6880 tree elt;
6882 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)); elt;
6883 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
6884 if (TREE_PURPOSE (elt) == TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)
6885 /* We can normally use the value of the field in the
6886 CONSTRUCTOR. However, if this is a bitfield in
6887 an integral mode that we can fit in a HOST_WIDE_INT,
6888 we must mask only the number of bits in the bitfield,
6889 since this is done implicitly by the constructor. If
6890 the bitfield does not meet either of those conditions,
6891 we can't do this optimization. */
6892 && (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_PURPOSE (elt))
6893 || ((GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)))
6894 == MODE_INT)
6895 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)))
6896 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))))
6898 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_PURPOSE (elt))
6899 && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
6900 target = 0;
6901 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_VALUE (elt), target, tmode, modifier);
6902 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)))
6904 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize
6905 = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)));
6906 enum machine_mode imode
6907 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)));
6909 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt))))
6911 op1 = GEN_INT (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1);
6912 op0 = expand_and (imode, op0, op1, target);
6914 else
6916 tree count
6917 = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
6918 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode) - bitsize);
6920 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
6921 target, 0);
6922 op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
6923 target, 0);
6927 return op0;
6930 goto normal_inner_ref;
6932 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6933 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6934 normal_inner_ref:
6936 enum machine_mode mode1;
6937 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
6938 tree offset;
6939 int volatilep = 0;
6940 tree tem = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
6941 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep);
6942 rtx orig_op0;
6944 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
6945 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
6946 infinitely recurse. */
6947 gcc_assert (tem != exp);
6949 /* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
6950 computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
6951 to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
6953 orig_op0 = op0
6954 = expand_expr (tem,
6955 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
6956 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
6957 != INTEGER_CST)
6958 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
6959 ? target : NULL_RTX),
6960 VOIDmode,
6961 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6962 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6963 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
6964 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
6966 /* If this is a constant, put it into a register if it is a
6967 legitimate constant and OFFSET is 0 and memory if it isn't. */
6968 if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
6970 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem));
6971 if (mode != BLKmode && LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (op0)
6972 && offset == 0)
6973 op0 = force_reg (mode, op0);
6974 else
6975 op0 = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, op0));
6978 /* Otherwise, if this object not in memory and we either have an
6979 offset or a BLKmode result, put it there. This case can't occur in
6980 C, but can in Ada if we have unchecked conversion of an expression
6981 from a scalar type to an array or record type or for an
6982 ARRAY_RANGE_REF whose type is BLKmode. */
6983 else if (!MEM_P (op0)
6984 && (offset != 0
6985 || (code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF && mode == BLKmode)))
6987 tree nt = build_qualified_type (TREE_TYPE (tem),
6988 (TYPE_QUALS (TREE_TYPE (tem))
6989 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST));
6990 rtx memloc = assign_temp (nt, 1, 1, 1);
6992 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
6993 op0 = memloc;
6996 if (offset != 0)
6998 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
6999 EXPAND_SUM);
7001 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0));
7003 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
7004 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != Pmode)
7005 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, offset_rtx, 0);
7006 #else
7007 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
7008 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
7009 #endif
7011 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode
7012 /* A constant address in OP0 can have VOIDmode, we must
7013 not try to call force_reg in that case. */
7014 && GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) != VOIDmode
7015 && bitsize != 0
7016 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
7017 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
7018 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
7020 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7021 bitpos = 0;
7024 op0 = offset_address (op0, offset_rtx,
7025 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
7028 /* If OFFSET is making OP0 more aligned than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT,
7029 record its alignment as BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
7030 if (MEM_P (op0) && bitpos == 0 && offset != 0
7031 && is_aligning_offset (offset, tem))
7032 set_mem_align (op0, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
7034 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
7035 if (MEM_P (op0) && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
7037 if (op0 == orig_op0)
7038 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
7040 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
7043 /* The following code doesn't handle CONCAT.
7044 Assume only bitpos == 0 can be used for CONCAT, due to
7045 one element arrays having the same mode as its element. */
7046 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT)
7048 gcc_assert (bitpos == 0
7049 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)));
7050 return op0;
7053 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
7054 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
7055 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
7056 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
7057 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
7058 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode. */
7059 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
7060 || REG_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
7061 || (mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
7062 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
7063 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
7064 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7065 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7066 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
7067 fetch it as a bit field. */
7068 || (mode1 != BLKmode
7069 && (((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
7070 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0)
7071 || (MEM_P (op0)
7072 && (MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)
7073 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1) != 0))))
7074 && ((modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7075 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7076 ? STRICT_ALIGNMENT
7077 : SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode1, MEM_ALIGN (op0))))
7078 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
7079 /* If the type and the field are a constant size and the
7080 size of the type isn't the same size as the bitfield,
7081 we must use bitfield operations. */
7082 || (bitsize >= 0
7083 && TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
7084 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
7085 && 0 != compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
7086 bitsize)))
7088 enum machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
7090 if (ext_mode == BLKmode
7091 && ! (target != 0 && MEM_P (op0)
7092 && MEM_P (target)
7093 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0))
7094 ext_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
7096 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
7098 if (target == 0)
7099 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
7101 if (bitsize == 0)
7102 return target;
7104 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
7105 TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
7106 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0)
7107 && (!target || MEM_P (target))
7108 && !(bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT));
7110 emit_block_move (target,
7111 adjust_address (op0, VOIDmode,
7112 bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT),
7113 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
7114 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
7115 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
7116 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
7118 return target;
7121 op0 = validize_mem (op0);
7123 if (MEM_P (op0) && REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
7124 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
7126 op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp,
7127 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
7128 ? NULL_RTX : target),
7129 ext_mode, ext_mode);
7131 /* If the result is a record type and BITSIZE is narrower than
7132 the mode of OP0, an integral mode, and this is a big endian
7133 machine, we must put the field into the high-order bits. */
7134 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
7135 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
7136 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
7137 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
7138 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
7139 - bitsize),
7140 op0, 1);
7142 /* If the result type is BLKmode, store the data into a temporary
7143 of the appropriate type, but with the mode corresponding to the
7144 mode for the data we have (op0's mode). It's tempting to make
7145 this a constant type, since we know it's only being stored once,
7146 but that can cause problems if we are taking the address of this
7147 COMPONENT_REF because the MEM of any reference via that address
7148 will have flags corresponding to the type, which will not
7149 necessarily be constant. */
7150 if (mode == BLKmode)
7152 rtx new
7153 = assign_stack_temp_for_type
7154 (ext_mode, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (ext_mode), 0, type);
7156 emit_move_insn (new, op0);
7157 op0 = copy_rtx (new);
7158 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
7159 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 1);
7162 return op0;
7165 /* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
7166 now as well. */
7167 if (mode == BLKmode)
7168 mode1 = BLKmode;
7170 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
7171 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7172 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7173 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7174 else
7175 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7177 if (op0 == orig_op0)
7178 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
7180 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 0);
7181 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
7182 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
7184 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
7185 if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
7186 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7187 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7188 return op0;
7189 else if (target == 0)
7190 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
7192 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
7193 return target;
7196 case OBJ_TYPE_REF:
7197 return expand_expr (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
7199 case CALL_EXPR:
7200 /* Check for a built-in function. */
7201 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
7202 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7203 == FUNCTION_DECL)
7204 && DECL_BUILT_IN (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
7206 if (DECL_BUILT_IN_CLASS (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7207 == BUILT_IN_FRONTEND)
7208 return lang_hooks.expand_expr (exp, original_target,
7209 tmode, modifier,
7210 alt_rtl);
7211 else
7212 return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
7215 return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
7217 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
7218 case NOP_EXPR:
7219 case CONVERT_EXPR:
7220 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) == error_mark_node)
7221 return const0_rtx;
7223 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
7225 tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7227 /* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion isn't doing
7228 anything except possibly changing memory attribute. */
7229 if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode)
7231 rtx result = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode,
7232 modifier);
7234 result = copy_rtx (result);
7235 set_mem_attributes (result, exp, 0);
7236 return result;
7239 if (target == 0)
7241 if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode)
7242 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
7243 else
7244 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
7247 if (MEM_P (target))
7248 /* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
7249 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
7250 adjust_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0),
7251 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
7253 else
7255 gcc_assert (REG_P (target));
7257 /* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
7258 store_field (target,
7259 MIN ((int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE
7260 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
7261 * BITS_PER_UNIT),
7262 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)),
7263 0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
7264 VOIDmode, 0, type, 0);
7267 /* Return the entire union. */
7268 return target;
7271 if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
7273 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, VOIDmode,
7274 modifier);
7276 /* If the signedness of the conversion differs and OP0 is
7277 a promoted SUBREG, clear that indication since we now
7278 have to do the proper extension. */
7279 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) != unsignedp
7280 && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
7281 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0) = 0;
7283 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
7286 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, mode, modifier);
7287 op0 = REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
7288 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
7289 return op0;
7291 /* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
7292 if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
7294 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7295 enum machine_mode inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (inner_type);
7297 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7298 return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, op0, inner_mode,
7299 subreg_lowpart_offset (mode,
7300 inner_mode));
7301 else
7302 return convert_modes (mode, inner_mode, op0,
7303 TYPE_UNSIGNED (inner_type));
7306 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7307 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
7309 if (target == 0)
7310 return
7311 convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
7312 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7313 else
7314 convert_move (target, op0,
7315 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7316 return target;
7318 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
7319 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, mode, modifier);
7321 /* If the input and output modes are both the same, we are done.
7322 Otherwise, if neither mode is BLKmode and both are integral and within
7323 a word, we can use gen_lowpart. If neither is true, make sure the
7324 operand is in memory and convert the MEM to the new mode. */
7325 if (TYPE_MODE (type) == GET_MODE (op0))
7327 else if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode && GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode
7328 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
7329 && GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (type)) == MODE_INT
7330 && GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD
7331 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
7332 op0 = gen_lowpart (TYPE_MODE (type), op0);
7333 else if (!MEM_P (op0))
7335 /* If the operand is not a MEM, force it into memory. Since we
7336 are going to be be changing the mode of the MEM, don't call
7337 force_const_mem for constants because we don't allow pool
7338 constants to change mode. */
7339 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7341 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
7343 if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (inner_type))
7344 target
7345 = assign_stack_temp_for_type
7346 (TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
7347 GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)), 0, inner_type);
7349 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
7350 op0 = target;
7353 /* At this point, OP0 is in the correct mode. If the output type is such
7354 that the operand is known to be aligned, indicate that it is.
7355 Otherwise, we need only be concerned about alignment for non-BLKmode
7356 results. */
7357 if (MEM_P (op0))
7359 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
7361 if (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (type))
7362 set_mem_align (op0, MAX (MEM_ALIGN (op0), TYPE_ALIGN (type)));
7363 else if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
7364 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (TYPE_MODE (type)))
7366 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7367 HOST_WIDE_INT temp_size
7368 = MAX (int_size_in_bytes (inner_type),
7369 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)));
7370 rtx new = assign_stack_temp_for_type (TYPE_MODE (type),
7371 temp_size, 0, type);
7372 rtx new_with_op0_mode = adjust_address (new, GET_MODE (op0), 0);
7374 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
7376 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode)
7377 emit_block_move (new_with_op0_mode, op0,
7378 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type))),
7379 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
7380 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
7381 else
7382 emit_move_insn (new_with_op0_mode, op0);
7384 op0 = new;
7387 op0 = adjust_address (op0, TYPE_MODE (type), 0);
7390 return op0;
7392 case PLUS_EXPR:
7393 /* If we are adding a constant, a VAR_DECL that is sp, fp, or ap, and
7394 something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
7395 then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
7396 reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
7397 frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
7399 fold-const.c will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
7400 PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
7401 sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
7402 the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
7404 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == PLUS_EXPR
7405 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1)) == INTEGER_CST
7406 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == VAR_DECL
7407 && (DECL_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == frame_pointer_rtx
7408 || DECL_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == stack_pointer_rtx
7409 || DECL_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == arg_pointer_rtx))
7411 tree t = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7413 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7414 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0) = t;
7417 /* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
7418 something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
7419 plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
7420 use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
7421 efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
7422 address.
7424 If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
7425 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7426 || (mode == ptr_mode && (unsignedp || ! flag_trapv)))
7428 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7429 target = 0;
7430 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == INTEGER_CST
7431 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7432 && TREE_CONSTANT (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
7434 rtx constant_part;
7436 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), subtarget, VOIDmode,
7437 EXPAND_SUM);
7438 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
7439 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
7440 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
7441 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
7442 constant_part
7443 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)),
7444 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
7445 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))));
7446 op1 = plus_constant (op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
7447 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7448 op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
7449 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op1);
7452 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
7453 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_INT
7454 && TREE_CONSTANT (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
7456 rtx constant_part;
7458 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode,
7459 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7460 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_SUM));
7461 if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
7463 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX,
7464 VOIDmode, modifier);
7465 /* Return a PLUS if modifier says it's OK. */
7466 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM
7467 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7468 return simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
7469 goto binop2;
7471 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
7472 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
7473 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
7474 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
7475 constant_part
7476 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)),
7477 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
7478 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7479 op0 = plus_constant (op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
7480 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7481 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
7482 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
7486 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
7487 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
7488 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
7489 zero-extend. */
7490 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7491 || mode != ptr_mode)
7493 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7494 subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
7495 if (op0 == const0_rtx)
7496 return op1;
7497 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
7498 return op0;
7499 goto binop2;
7502 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7503 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
7504 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
7506 case MINUS_EXPR:
7507 /* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
7508 symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
7509 are constant. */
7510 /* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
7511 for the sake of an initializer. */
7512 if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7513 && really_constant_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
7514 && really_constant_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
7516 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7517 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
7519 /* If the last operand is a CONST_INT, use plus_constant of
7520 the negated constant. Else make the MINUS. */
7521 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
7522 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (plus_constant (op0, - INTVAL (op1)));
7523 else
7524 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, op0, op1));
7527 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
7528 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
7529 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
7530 zero-extend. */
7531 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7532 || mode != ptr_mode)
7533 goto binop;
7535 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7536 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
7538 /* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
7539 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
7541 op1 = negate_rtx (mode, op1);
7542 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
7545 goto binop2;
7547 case MULT_EXPR:
7548 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
7549 Thus the following special case checks need only
7550 check the second operand. */
7551 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == INTEGER_CST)
7553 tree t1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7554 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7555 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = t1;
7558 /* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
7559 indexed address, for machines that support that. */
7561 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
7562 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
7564 tree exp1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7566 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode,
7567 EXPAND_SUM);
7569 if (!REG_P (op0))
7570 op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
7571 if (!REG_P (op0))
7572 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
7574 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0,
7575 gen_int_mode (tree_low_cst (exp1, 0),
7576 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp1)))));
7579 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7580 target = 0;
7582 /* Check for multiplying things that have been extended
7583 from a narrower type. If this machine supports multiplying
7584 in that narrower type with a result in the desired type,
7585 do it that way, and avoid the explicit type-conversion. */
7586 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == NOP_EXPR
7587 && TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE
7588 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
7589 < TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
7590 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
7591 && int_fits_type_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7592 TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
7593 /* Don't use a widening multiply if a shift will do. */
7594 && ((GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
7595 > HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7596 || exact_log2 (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) < 0))
7598 (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == NOP_EXPR
7599 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE
7600 (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0)))
7601 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE
7602 (TREE_OPERAND
7603 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))))
7604 /* If both operands are extended, they must either both
7605 be zero-extended or both be sign-extended. */
7606 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
7607 (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0)))
7608 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
7609 (TREE_OPERAND
7610 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))))))
7612 tree op0type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0));
7613 enum machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (op0type);
7614 bool zextend_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (op0type);
7615 optab other_optab = zextend_p ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab;
7616 this_optab = zextend_p ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab;
7618 if (mode == GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (innermode))
7620 if (this_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7622 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
7623 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
7624 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7625 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, 0);
7626 else
7627 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
7628 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0),
7629 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, 0);
7630 goto binop3;
7632 else if (other_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing
7633 && innermode == word_mode)
7635 rtx htem, hipart;
7636 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
7637 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7638 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
7639 op1 = convert_modes (innermode, mode,
7640 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7641 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0),
7642 unsignedp);
7643 else
7644 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0),
7645 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7646 temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
7647 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7648 hipart = gen_highpart (innermode, temp);
7649 htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (innermode, hipart,
7650 op0, op1, hipart,
7651 zextend_p);
7652 if (htem != hipart)
7653 emit_move_insn (hipart, htem);
7654 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
7658 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7659 subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
7660 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
7662 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
7663 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
7664 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
7665 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
7666 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
7667 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7668 target = 0;
7669 /* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
7670 then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
7671 where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
7672 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7673 subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
7674 return expand_divmod (0, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
7676 case RDIV_EXPR:
7677 /* Emit a/b as a*(1/b). Later we may manage CSE the reciprocal saving
7678 expensive divide. If not, combine will rebuild the original
7679 computation. */
7680 if (flag_unsafe_math_optimizations && optimize && !optimize_size
7681 && TREE_CODE (type) == REAL_TYPE
7682 && !real_onep (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
7683 return expand_expr (build2 (MULT_EXPR, type, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
7684 build2 (RDIV_EXPR, type,
7685 build_real (type, dconst1),
7686 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))),
7687 target, tmode, modifier);
7689 goto binop;
7691 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
7692 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
7693 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
7694 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
7695 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7696 target = 0;
7697 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7698 subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
7699 return expand_divmod (1, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
7701 case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
7702 case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
7703 case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
7704 gcc_unreachable (); /* Not used for C. */
7706 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
7707 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7708 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7709 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7710 expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
7711 return target;
7713 case FLOAT_EXPR:
7714 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7715 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7716 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7717 /* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
7718 So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
7719 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
7720 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))),
7721 op0);
7722 expand_float (target, op0,
7723 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7724 return target;
7726 case NEGATE_EXPR:
7727 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7728 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7729 target = 0;
7730 temp = expand_unop (mode,
7731 optab_for_tree_code (NEGATE_EXPR, type),
7732 op0, target, 0);
7733 gcc_assert (temp);
7734 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
7736 case ABS_EXPR:
7737 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7738 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7739 target = 0;
7741 /* ABS_EXPR is not valid for complex arguments. */
7742 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
7743 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT);
7745 /* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
7746 risk generating incorrect code below. */
7747 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
7748 return op0;
7750 return expand_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp,
7751 safe_from_p (target, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1));
7753 case MAX_EXPR:
7754 case MIN_EXPR:
7755 target = original_target;
7756 if (target == 0
7757 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
7758 || (MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
7759 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
7760 || (REG_P (target)
7761 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
7762 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7763 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7764 target, &op0, &op1, 0);
7766 /* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
7767 If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
7768 value. */
7769 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type);
7770 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
7771 OPTAB_WIDEN);
7772 if (temp != 0)
7773 return temp;
7775 /* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
7776 code without it. */
7778 if (MEM_P (target))
7779 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7781 /* If op1 was placed in target, swap op0 and op1. */
7782 if (target != op0 && target == op1)
7784 rtx tem = op0;
7785 op0 = op1;
7786 op1 = tem;
7789 if (target != op0)
7790 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
7792 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
7794 /* If this mode is an integer too wide to compare properly,
7795 compare word by word. Rely on cse to optimize constant cases. */
7796 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
7797 && ! can_compare_p (GE, mode, ccp_jump))
7799 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
7800 do_jump_by_parts_greater_rtx (mode, unsignedp, target, op1,
7801 NULL_RTX, op0);
7802 else
7803 do_jump_by_parts_greater_rtx (mode, unsignedp, op1, target,
7804 NULL_RTX, op0);
7806 else
7808 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, op1, code == MAX_EXPR ? GE : LE,
7809 unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, op0);
7811 emit_move_insn (target, op1);
7812 emit_label (op0);
7813 return target;
7815 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
7816 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7817 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7818 target = 0;
7819 temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
7820 gcc_assert (temp);
7821 return temp;
7823 /* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
7824 Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
7825 and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
7826 but that is probably not worth while. */
7828 /* BIT_AND_EXPR is for bitwise anding. TRUTH_AND_EXPR is for anding two
7829 boolean values when we want in all cases to compute both of them. In
7830 general it is fastest to do TRUTH_AND_EXPR by computing both operands
7831 as actual zero-or-1 values and then bitwise anding. In cases where
7832 there cannot be any side effects, better code would be made by
7833 treating TRUTH_AND_EXPR like TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR; but the question is
7834 how to recognize those cases. */
7836 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
7837 code = BIT_AND_EXPR;
7838 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
7839 goto binop;
7841 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
7842 code = BIT_IOR_EXPR;
7843 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
7844 goto binop;
7846 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
7847 code = BIT_XOR_EXPR;
7848 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
7849 goto binop;
7851 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
7852 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
7853 case LROTATE_EXPR:
7854 case RROTATE_EXPR:
7855 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
7856 subtarget = 0;
7857 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7858 target = 0;
7859 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7860 return expand_shift (code, mode, op0, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target,
7861 unsignedp);
7863 /* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
7864 the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
7865 case LT_EXPR:
7866 case LE_EXPR:
7867 case GT_EXPR:
7868 case GE_EXPR:
7869 case EQ_EXPR:
7870 case NE_EXPR:
7871 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
7872 case ORDERED_EXPR:
7873 case UNLT_EXPR:
7874 case UNLE_EXPR:
7875 case UNGT_EXPR:
7876 case UNGE_EXPR:
7877 case UNEQ_EXPR:
7878 case LTGT_EXPR:
7879 temp = do_store_flag (exp,
7880 modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? target : NULL_RTX,
7881 tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode, 0);
7882 if (temp != 0)
7883 return temp;
7885 /* For foo != 0, load foo, and if it is nonzero load 1 instead. */
7886 if (code == NE_EXPR && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
7887 && original_target
7888 && REG_P (original_target)
7889 && (GET_MODE (original_target)
7890 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
7892 temp = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), original_target,
7893 VOIDmode, 0);
7895 /* If temp is constant, we can just compute the result. */
7896 if (GET_CODE (temp) == CONST_INT)
7898 if (INTVAL (temp) != 0)
7899 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
7900 else
7901 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
7903 return target;
7906 if (temp != original_target)
7908 enum machine_mode mode1 = GET_MODE (temp);
7909 if (mode1 == VOIDmode)
7910 mode1 = tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode;
7912 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (mode1, temp);
7915 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
7916 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (temp, const0_rtx, EQ, NULL_RTX,
7917 GET_MODE (temp), unsignedp, op1);
7918 emit_move_insn (temp, const1_rtx);
7919 emit_label (op1);
7920 return temp;
7923 /* If no set-flag instruction, must generate a conditional store
7924 into a temporary variable. Drop through and handle this
7925 like && and ||. */
7927 if (! ignore
7928 && (target == 0
7929 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
7930 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
7931 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
7932 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
7933 || (!optimize && REG_P (target)
7934 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
7935 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
7937 if (target)
7938 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
7940 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
7941 jumpifnot (exp, op1);
7943 if (target)
7944 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
7946 emit_label (op1);
7947 return ignore ? const0_rtx : target;
7949 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
7950 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7951 target = 0;
7952 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, VOIDmode, 0);
7953 /* The parser is careful to generate TRUTH_NOT_EXPR
7954 only with operands that are always zero or one. */
7955 temp = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, op0, const1_rtx,
7956 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7957 gcc_assert (temp);
7958 return temp;
7960 case STATEMENT_LIST:
7962 tree_stmt_iterator iter;
7964 gcc_assert (ignore);
7966 for (iter = tsi_start (exp); !tsi_end_p (iter); tsi_next (&iter))
7967 expand_expr (tsi_stmt (iter), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
7969 return const0_rtx;
7971 case COND_EXPR:
7972 /* If it's void, we don't need to worry about computing a value. */
7973 if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7975 tree pred = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7976 tree then_ = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7977 tree else_ = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
7979 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (then_) == GOTO_EXPR
7980 && TREE_CODE (GOTO_DESTINATION (then_)) == LABEL_DECL
7981 && TREE_CODE (else_) == GOTO_EXPR
7982 && TREE_CODE (GOTO_DESTINATION (else_)) == LABEL_DECL);
7984 jumpif (pred, label_rtx (GOTO_DESTINATION (then_)));
7985 return expand_expr (else_, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
7988 /* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
7989 are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
7990 a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
7991 for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
7993 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)
7994 && !ignore
7995 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) != void_type_node
7996 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)) != void_type_node);
7998 /* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
7999 if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
8000 intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
8001 temporary. */
8003 if (modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8004 && original_target
8005 && safe_from_p (original_target, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1)
8006 && GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
8007 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
8008 && (! can_conditionally_move_p (mode)
8009 || REG_P (original_target))
8010 #endif
8011 && !MEM_P (original_target))
8012 temp = original_target;
8013 else
8014 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0, 1);
8016 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
8017 NO_DEFER_POP;
8018 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
8019 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
8020 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
8021 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), temp,
8022 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
8024 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (op1));
8025 emit_barrier ();
8026 emit_label (op0);
8027 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), temp,
8028 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
8030 emit_label (op1);
8031 OK_DEFER_POP;
8032 return temp;
8034 case MODIFY_EXPR:
8036 /* If lhs is complex, expand calls in rhs before computing it.
8037 That's so we don't compute a pointer and save it over a
8038 call. If lhs is simple, compute it first so we can give it
8039 as a target if the rhs is just a call. This avoids an
8040 extra temp and copy and that prevents a partial-subsumption
8041 which makes bad code. Actually we could treat
8042 component_ref's of vars like vars. */
8044 tree lhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8045 tree rhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8047 temp = 0;
8049 /* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
8050 of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
8051 assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
8052 test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
8054 ??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
8055 things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
8056 support it. */
8057 if (ignore
8058 && TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
8059 && (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
8060 || TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
8061 && TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
8062 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
8063 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1)))
8064 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))))
8066 rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
8068 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1),
8069 TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? label : 0,
8070 TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR ? label : 0);
8071 expand_assignment (lhs, convert (TREE_TYPE (rhs),
8072 (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
8073 ? integer_one_node
8074 : integer_zero_node)),
8076 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
8077 emit_label (label);
8078 return const0_rtx;
8081 temp = expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, ! ignore);
8083 return temp;
8086 case RETURN_EXPR:
8087 if (!TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
8088 expand_null_return ();
8089 else
8090 expand_return (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
8091 return const0_rtx;
8093 case ADDR_EXPR:
8094 return expand_expr_addr_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
8096 /* COMPLEX type for Extended Pascal & Fortran */
8097 case COMPLEX_EXPR:
8099 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8100 rtx insns;
8102 /* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
8103 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
8104 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
8106 if (! target)
8107 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8109 start_sequence ();
8111 /* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
8112 emit_move_insn (gen_realpart (mode, target), op0);
8113 emit_move_insn (gen_imagpart (mode, target), op1);
8115 insns = get_insns ();
8116 end_sequence ();
8118 /* Complex construction should appear as a single unit. */
8119 /* If TARGET is a CONCAT, we got insns like RD = RS, ID = IS,
8120 each with a separate pseudo as destination.
8121 It's not correct for flow to treat them as a unit. */
8122 if (GET_CODE (target) != CONCAT)
8123 emit_no_conflict_block (insns, target, op0, op1, NULL_RTX);
8124 else
8125 emit_insn (insns);
8127 return target;
8130 case REALPART_EXPR:
8131 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
8132 return gen_realpart (mode, op0);
8134 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
8135 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
8136 return gen_imagpart (mode, op0);
8138 case RESX_EXPR:
8139 expand_resx_expr (exp);
8140 return const0_rtx;
8142 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
8143 case CATCH_EXPR:
8144 case EH_FILTER_EXPR:
8145 case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
8146 /* Lowered by tree-eh.c. */
8147 gcc_unreachable ();
8149 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
8150 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
8151 case TARGET_EXPR:
8152 case CASE_LABEL_EXPR:
8153 case VA_ARG_EXPR:
8154 case BIND_EXPR:
8155 case INIT_EXPR:
8156 case CONJ_EXPR:
8157 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
8158 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
8159 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
8160 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
8161 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
8162 case LOOP_EXPR:
8163 case EXIT_EXPR:
8164 case LABELED_BLOCK_EXPR:
8165 case EXIT_BLOCK_EXPR:
8166 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
8167 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
8168 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
8169 gcc_unreachable ();
8171 case EXC_PTR_EXPR:
8172 return get_exception_pointer (cfun);
8174 case FILTER_EXPR:
8175 return get_exception_filter (cfun);
8177 case FDESC_EXPR:
8178 /* Function descriptors are not valid except for as
8179 initialization constants, and should not be expanded. */
8180 gcc_unreachable ();
8182 case SWITCH_EXPR:
8183 expand_case (exp);
8184 return const0_rtx;
8186 case LABEL_EXPR:
8187 expand_label (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
8188 return const0_rtx;
8190 case ASM_EXPR:
8191 expand_asm_expr (exp);
8192 return const0_rtx;
8194 case WITH_SIZE_EXPR:
8195 /* WITH_SIZE_EXPR expands to its first argument. The caller should
8196 have pulled out the size to use in whatever context it needed. */
8197 return expand_expr_real (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), original_target, tmode,
8198 modifier, alt_rtl);
8200 default:
8201 return lang_hooks.expand_expr (exp, original_target, tmode,
8202 modifier, alt_rtl);
8205 /* Here to do an ordinary binary operator. */
8206 binop:
8207 expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
8208 subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
8209 binop2:
8210 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type);
8211 binop3:
8212 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8213 target = 0;
8214 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
8215 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8216 gcc_assert (temp);
8217 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8219 #undef REDUCE_BIT_FIELD
8221 /* Subroutine of above: reduce EXP to the precision of TYPE (in the
8222 signedness of TYPE), possibly returning the result in TARGET. */
8223 static rtx
8224 reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx exp, rtx target, tree type)
8226 HOST_WIDE_INT prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
8227 if (target && GET_MODE (target) != GET_MODE (exp))
8228 target = 0;
8229 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8231 rtx mask;
8232 if (prec < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8233 mask = immed_double_const (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << prec) - 1, 0,
8234 GET_MODE (exp));
8235 else
8236 mask = immed_double_const ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) -1,
8237 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
8238 << (prec - HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)) - 1,
8239 GET_MODE (exp));
8240 return expand_and (GET_MODE (exp), exp, mask, target);
8242 else
8244 tree count = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
8245 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (exp)) - prec);
8246 exp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp), exp, count, target, 0);
8247 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp), exp, count, target, 0);
8251 /* Subroutine of above: returns 1 if OFFSET corresponds to an offset that
8252 when applied to the address of EXP produces an address known to be
8253 aligned more than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
8255 static int
8256 is_aligning_offset (tree offset, tree exp)
8258 /* Strip off any conversions. */
8259 while (TREE_CODE (offset) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
8260 || TREE_CODE (offset) == NOP_EXPR
8261 || TREE_CODE (offset) == CONVERT_EXPR)
8262 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
8264 /* We must now have a BIT_AND_EXPR with a constant that is one less than
8265 power of 2 and which is larger than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
8266 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != BIT_AND_EXPR
8267 || !host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1)
8268 || compare_tree_int (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1),
8269 BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT) <= 0
8270 || !exact_log2 (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1) + 1) < 0)
8271 return 0;
8273 /* Look at the first operand of BIT_AND_EXPR and strip any conversion.
8274 It must be NEGATE_EXPR. Then strip any more conversions. */
8275 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
8276 while (TREE_CODE (offset) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
8277 || TREE_CODE (offset) == NOP_EXPR
8278 || TREE_CODE (offset) == CONVERT_EXPR)
8279 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
8281 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != NEGATE_EXPR)
8282 return 0;
8284 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
8285 while (TREE_CODE (offset) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
8286 || TREE_CODE (offset) == NOP_EXPR
8287 || TREE_CODE (offset) == CONVERT_EXPR)
8288 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
8290 /* This must now be the address of EXP. */
8291 return TREE_CODE (offset) == ADDR_EXPR && TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0) == exp;
8294 /* Return the tree node if an ARG corresponds to a string constant or zero
8295 if it doesn't. If we return nonzero, set *PTR_OFFSET to the offset
8296 in bytes within the string that ARG is accessing. The type of the
8297 offset will be `sizetype'. */
8299 tree
8300 string_constant (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset)
8302 STRIP_NOPS (arg);
8304 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR
8305 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == STRING_CST)
8307 *ptr_offset = size_zero_node;
8308 return TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
8310 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR
8311 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == ARRAY_REF
8312 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0)) == STRING_CST)
8314 *ptr_offset = convert (sizetype, TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1));
8315 return TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
8317 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR)
8319 tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
8320 tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
8322 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
8323 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
8325 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == ADDR_EXPR
8326 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == STRING_CST)
8328 *ptr_offset = convert (sizetype, arg1);
8329 return TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0);
8331 else if (TREE_CODE (arg1) == ADDR_EXPR
8332 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == STRING_CST)
8334 *ptr_offset = convert (sizetype, arg0);
8335 return TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0);
8339 return 0;
8342 /* Generate code to calculate EXP using a store-flag instruction
8343 and return an rtx for the result. EXP is either a comparison
8344 or a TRUTH_NOT_EXPR whose operand is a comparison.
8346 If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
8348 If ONLY_CHEAP is nonzero, only do this if it is likely to be very
8349 cheap.
8351 Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
8352 available on this machine.
8354 Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
8355 we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
8356 re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
8357 emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
8358 to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
8359 it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
8360 set/jump/set sequence. */
8362 static rtx
8363 do_store_flag (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode mode, int only_cheap)
8365 enum rtx_code code;
8366 tree arg0, arg1, type;
8367 tree tem;
8368 enum machine_mode operand_mode;
8369 int invert = 0;
8370 int unsignedp;
8371 rtx op0, op1;
8372 enum insn_code icode;
8373 rtx subtarget = target;
8374 rtx result, label;
8376 /* If this is a TRUTH_NOT_EXPR, set a flag indicating we must invert the
8377 result at the end. We can't simply invert the test since it would
8378 have already been inverted if it were valid. This case occurs for
8379 some floating-point comparisons. */
8381 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TRUTH_NOT_EXPR)
8382 invert = 1, exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8384 arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8385 arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8387 /* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
8388 if (arg0 == error_mark_node || arg1 == error_mark_node)
8389 return const0_rtx;
8391 type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
8392 operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8393 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8395 /* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
8396 passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
8397 if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
8398 return 0;
8400 /* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
8401 when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
8402 #ifdef HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
8403 if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
8404 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == POINTER_TYPE
8405 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
8406 == FUNCTION_TYPE))
8407 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) == POINTER_TYPE
8408 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
8409 == FUNCTION_TYPE))))
8410 return 0;
8411 #endif
8413 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
8414 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
8416 /* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
8417 operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
8418 converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
8419 below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
8420 tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
8421 are rarely passed as the first operand. */
8423 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
8425 case EQ_EXPR:
8426 code = EQ;
8427 break;
8428 case NE_EXPR:
8429 code = NE;
8430 break;
8431 case LT_EXPR:
8432 if (integer_onep (arg1))
8433 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
8434 else
8435 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
8436 break;
8437 case LE_EXPR:
8438 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
8439 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
8440 else
8441 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
8442 break;
8443 case GT_EXPR:
8444 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
8445 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
8446 else
8447 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
8448 break;
8449 case GE_EXPR:
8450 if (integer_onep (arg1))
8451 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
8452 else
8453 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
8454 break;
8456 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
8457 code = UNORDERED;
8458 break;
8459 case ORDERED_EXPR:
8460 code = ORDERED;
8461 break;
8462 case UNLT_EXPR:
8463 code = UNLT;
8464 break;
8465 case UNLE_EXPR:
8466 code = UNLE;
8467 break;
8468 case UNGT_EXPR:
8469 code = UNGT;
8470 break;
8471 case UNGE_EXPR:
8472 code = UNGE;
8473 break;
8474 case UNEQ_EXPR:
8475 code = UNEQ;
8476 break;
8477 case LTGT_EXPR:
8478 code = LTGT;
8479 break;
8481 default:
8482 gcc_unreachable ();
8485 /* Put a constant second. */
8486 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST)
8488 tem = arg0; arg0 = arg1; arg1 = tem;
8489 code = swap_condition (code);
8492 /* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
8493 do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
8494 masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
8495 we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
8496 than an scc insn even if we have it.
8498 The code to make this transformation was moved into fold_single_bit_test,
8499 so we just call into the folder and expand its result. */
8501 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
8502 && TREE_CODE (arg0) == BIT_AND_EXPR && integer_zerop (arg1)
8503 && integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 1)))
8505 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
8506 return expand_expr (fold_single_bit_test (code == NE ? NE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR,
8507 arg0, arg1, type),
8508 target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8511 /* Now see if we are likely to be able to do this. Return if not. */
8512 if (! can_compare_p (code, operand_mode, ccp_store_flag))
8513 return 0;
8515 icode = setcc_gen_code[(int) code];
8516 if (icode == CODE_FOR_nothing
8517 || (only_cheap && insn_data[(int) icode].operand[0].mode != mode))
8519 /* We can only do this if it is one of the special cases that
8520 can be handled without an scc insn. */
8521 if ((code == LT && integer_zerop (arg1))
8522 || (! only_cheap && code == GE && integer_zerop (arg1)))
8524 else if (BRANCH_COST >= 0
8525 && ! only_cheap && (code == NE || code == EQ)
8526 && TREE_CODE (type) != REAL_TYPE
8527 && ((abs_optab->handlers[(int) operand_mode].insn_code
8528 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8529 || (ffs_optab->handlers[(int) operand_mode].insn_code
8530 != CODE_FOR_nothing)))
8532 else
8533 return 0;
8536 if (! get_subtarget (target)
8537 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode)
8538 subtarget = 0;
8540 expand_operands (arg0, arg1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
8542 if (target == 0)
8543 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8545 result = emit_store_flag (target, code, op0, op1,
8546 operand_mode, unsignedp, 1);
8548 if (result)
8550 if (invert)
8551 result = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, result, const1_rtx,
8552 result, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8553 return result;
8556 /* If this failed, we have to do this with set/compare/jump/set code. */
8557 if (!REG_P (target)
8558 || reg_mentioned_p (target, op0) || reg_mentioned_p (target, op1))
8559 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (target));
8561 emit_move_insn (target, invert ? const0_rtx : const1_rtx);
8562 result = compare_from_rtx (op0, op1, code, unsignedp,
8563 operand_mode, NULL_RTX);
8564 if (GET_CODE (result) == CONST_INT)
8565 return (((result == const0_rtx && ! invert)
8566 || (result != const0_rtx && invert))
8567 ? const0_rtx : const1_rtx);
8569 /* The code of RESULT may not match CODE if compare_from_rtx
8570 decided to swap its operands and reverse the original code.
8572 We know that compare_from_rtx returns either a CONST_INT or
8573 a new comparison code, so it is safe to just extract the
8574 code from RESULT. */
8575 code = GET_CODE (result);
8577 label = gen_label_rtx ();
8578 gcc_assert (bcc_gen_fctn[(int) code]);
8580 emit_jump_insn ((*bcc_gen_fctn[(int) code]) (label));
8581 emit_move_insn (target, invert ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx);
8582 emit_label (label);
8584 return target;
8588 /* Stubs in case we haven't got a casesi insn. */
8589 #ifndef HAVE_casesi
8590 # define HAVE_casesi 0
8591 # define gen_casesi(a, b, c, d, e) (0)
8592 # define CODE_FOR_casesi CODE_FOR_nothing
8593 #endif
8595 /* If the machine does not have a case insn that compares the bounds,
8596 this means extra overhead for dispatch tables, which raises the
8597 threshold for using them. */
8598 #ifndef CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8599 #define CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (HAVE_casesi ? 4 : 5)
8600 #endif /* CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD */
8602 unsigned int
8603 case_values_threshold (void)
8605 return CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD;
8608 /* Attempt to generate a casesi instruction. Returns 1 if successful,
8609 0 otherwise (i.e. if there is no casesi instruction). */
8611 try_casesi (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
8612 rtx table_label ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx default_label)
8614 enum machine_mode index_mode = SImode;
8615 int index_bits = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode);
8616 rtx op1, op2, index;
8617 enum machine_mode op_mode;
8619 if (! HAVE_casesi)
8620 return 0;
8622 /* Convert the index to SImode. */
8623 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (index_type)) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode))
8625 enum machine_mode omode = TYPE_MODE (index_type);
8626 rtx rangertx = expand_expr (range, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8628 /* We must handle the endpoints in the original mode. */
8629 index_expr = build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
8630 index_expr, minval);
8631 minval = integer_zero_node;
8632 index = expand_expr (index_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8633 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (rangertx, index, LTU, NULL_RTX,
8634 omode, 1, default_label);
8635 /* Now we can safely truncate. */
8636 index = convert_to_mode (index_mode, index, 0);
8638 else
8640 if (TYPE_MODE (index_type) != index_mode)
8642 index_expr = convert (lang_hooks.types.type_for_size
8643 (index_bits, 0), index_expr);
8644 index_type = TREE_TYPE (index_expr);
8647 index = expand_expr (index_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8650 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
8652 op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[0].mode;
8653 if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[0].predicate)
8654 (index, op_mode))
8655 index = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, index);
8657 op1 = expand_expr (minval, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8659 op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[1].mode;
8660 op1 = convert_modes (op_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (minval)),
8661 op1, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (minval)));
8662 if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[1].predicate)
8663 (op1, op_mode))
8664 op1 = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, op1);
8666 op2 = expand_expr (range, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8668 op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[2].mode;
8669 op2 = convert_modes (op_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
8670 op2, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range)));
8671 if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[2].predicate)
8672 (op2, op_mode))
8673 op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, op2);
8675 emit_jump_insn (gen_casesi (index, op1, op2,
8676 table_label, default_label));
8677 return 1;
8680 /* Attempt to generate a tablejump instruction; same concept. */
8681 #ifndef HAVE_tablejump
8682 #define HAVE_tablejump 0
8683 #define gen_tablejump(x, y) (0)
8684 #endif
8686 /* Subroutine of the next function.
8688 INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
8689 in the table already subtracted.
8690 MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
8691 RANGE is the length of the jump table.
8692 TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
8694 DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
8695 index value is out of range. */
8697 static void
8698 do_tablejump (rtx index, enum machine_mode mode, rtx range, rtx table_label,
8699 rtx default_label)
8701 rtx temp, vector;
8703 if (INTVAL (range) > cfun->max_jumptable_ents)
8704 cfun->max_jumptable_ents = INTVAL (range);
8706 /* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
8707 expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
8708 Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
8709 from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
8710 check that the original index expression value is both greater than
8711 or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
8712 the maximum value of the range. */
8714 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
8715 default_label);
8717 /* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
8718 Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
8719 if (mode != Pmode)
8720 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
8722 /* Don't let a MEM slip through, because then INDEX that comes
8723 out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
8724 and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
8725 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
8726 if (flag_pic && !REG_P (index))
8727 index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
8728 #endif
8730 /* If flag_force_addr were to affect this address
8731 it could interfere with the tricky assumptions made
8732 about addresses that contain label-refs,
8733 which may be valid only very near the tablejump itself. */
8734 /* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
8735 GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
8736 uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
8737 could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
8738 index = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
8739 gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, index,
8740 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE))),
8741 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
8742 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
8743 if (flag_pic)
8744 index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
8745 else
8746 #endif
8747 index = memory_address_noforce (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
8748 temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
8749 vector = gen_const_mem (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
8750 convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
8752 emit_jump_insn (gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
8754 /* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
8755 table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
8756 if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
8757 emit_barrier ();
8761 try_tablejump (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
8762 rtx table_label, rtx default_label)
8764 rtx index;
8766 if (! HAVE_tablejump)
8767 return 0;
8769 index_expr = fold (build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
8770 convert (index_type, index_expr),
8771 convert (index_type, minval)));
8772 index = expand_expr (index_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8773 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
8775 do_tablejump (index, TYPE_MODE (index_type),
8776 convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (index_type),
8777 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
8778 expand_expr (range, NULL_RTX,
8779 VOIDmode, 0),
8780 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range))),
8781 table_label, default_label);
8782 return 1;
8785 /* Nonzero if the mode is a valid vector mode for this architecture.
8786 This returns nonzero even if there is no hardware support for the
8787 vector mode, but we can emulate with narrower modes. */
8790 vector_mode_valid_p (enum machine_mode mode)
8792 enum mode_class class = GET_MODE_CLASS (mode);
8793 enum machine_mode innermode;
8795 /* Doh! What's going on? */
8796 if (class != MODE_VECTOR_INT
8797 && class != MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT)
8798 return 0;
8800 /* Hardware support. Woo hoo! */
8801 if (targetm.vector_mode_supported_p (mode))
8802 return 1;
8804 innermode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
8806 /* We should probably return 1 if requesting V4DI and we have no DI,
8807 but we have V2DI, but this is probably very unlikely. */
8809 /* If we have support for the inner mode, we can safely emulate it.
8810 We may not have V2DI, but me can emulate with a pair of DIs. */
8811 return targetm.scalar_mode_supported_p (innermode);
8814 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx for a VECTOR_CST tree. */
8815 static rtx
8816 const_vector_from_tree (tree exp)
8818 rtvec v;
8819 int units, i;
8820 tree link, elt;
8821 enum machine_mode inner, mode;
8823 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
8825 if (initializer_zerop (exp))
8826 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
8828 units = GET_MODE_NUNITS (mode);
8829 inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
8831 v = rtvec_alloc (units);
8833 link = TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (exp);
8834 for (i = 0; link; link = TREE_CHAIN (link), ++i)
8836 elt = TREE_VALUE (link);
8838 if (TREE_CODE (elt) == REAL_CST)
8839 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (elt),
8840 inner);
8841 else
8842 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (elt),
8843 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (elt),
8844 inner);
8847 /* Initialize remaining elements to 0. */
8848 for (; i < units; ++i)
8849 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST0_RTX (inner);
8851 return gen_rtx_CONST_VECTOR (mode, v);
8853 #include "gt-expr.h"